blob: fdcdb04fae2495d6f39f6ca34b7f1eb771fc46c7 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaue54b43a2019-11-25 19:47:40 +01007 2019/11/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100676. Cache
686.1. Limitation
696.2. Setup
706.2.1. Cache section
716.2.2. Proxy section
72
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200737. Using ACLs and fetching samples
747.1. ACL basics
757.1.1. Matching booleans
767.1.2. Matching integers
777.1.3. Matching strings
787.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
797.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
807.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
817.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
827.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200837.3.1. Converters
847.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
857.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
867.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
877.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
887.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200897.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090
918. Logging
928.1. Log levels
938.2. Log formats
948.2.1. Default log format
958.2.2. TCP log format
968.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100978.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100988.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200998.3. Advanced logging options
1008.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1018.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1028.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1038.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1048.4. Timing events
1058.5. Session state at disconnection
1068.6. Non-printable characters
1078.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1088.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1098.9. Examples of logs
110
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001119. Supported filters
1129.1. Trace
1139.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001149.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001159.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001169.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200117
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011810. FastCGI applications
11910.1. Setup
12010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12110.1.2. Proxy section
12210.1.3. Example
12310.2. Default parameters
12410.3. Limitations
125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126
1271. Quick reminder about HTTP
128----------------------------
129
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100130When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
132on almost anything found in the contents.
133
134However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
135formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
136correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
137
138
1391.1. The HTTP transaction model
140-------------------------------
141
142The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100143to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100144from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
145connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146will involve a new connection :
147
148 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
149
150In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
151establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
152by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
153length.
154
155Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
156to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
157however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
158response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
159header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
160
161 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
162
163Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
164power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
165but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200166a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100168Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
170second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
171page :
172
173 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
174
175This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
176latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
177correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
178the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100179server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
182time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
183are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
184parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
185carry the stream identifier.
186
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
188connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
189leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
191processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
192waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200193
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200194HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100195 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
196 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100197 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200199 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100201For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
202the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100203server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
204is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
205servers.
206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207
2081.2. HTTP request
209-----------------
210
211First, let's consider this HTTP request :
212
213 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100214 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
216 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
217 3 User-agent: my small browser
218 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
219 5 Accept: image/png
220
221
2221.2.1. The Request line
223-----------------------
224
225Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
226
227 - a METHOD : GET
228 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
229 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
230
231All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
232which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
233followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
234is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
235desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
236the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
237
238The URI itself can have several forms :
239
240 - A "relative URI" :
241
242 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
243
244 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
245 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
246
247 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
248
249 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
250
251 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
252 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
253 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
254 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
255 must accept this form too.
256
257 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
258 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
259 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200261 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
262 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
263 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
264 other protocols too.
265
266In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
267mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
268on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
269It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
270specific to the language, framework or application in use.
271
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100273assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
275received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
276processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
277as well as in server logs.
278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
295as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296
297The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
298that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
299is one valid form of empty line.
300
301Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
302headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
303about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
304application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
305
306Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000307 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
309 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
310 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
311
312
3131.3. HTTP response
314------------------
315
316An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
317messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
318
319 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
322 2 Content-length: 350
323 3 Content-Type: text/html
324
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200325As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
326codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
327response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100328continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
329the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
330following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
331sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
332(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
333correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
334such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
335state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
336over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
337if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
338information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003411.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342------------------------
343
344Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
345
346 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
347 - a status code : 200
348 - a reason : OK
349
350The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100351 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
352 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
353 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
354 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
355 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000357Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100358"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
360messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
361or "Authentication Required".
362
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100363HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
365 Code When / reason
366 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
367 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100370 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372 400 for an invalid or too large request
373 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
374 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200375 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
479
480 Example:
481
482 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
483
484 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
485
486 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
487
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200488Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
489file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
492 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
493
494* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
495 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
496 directory.
497
498* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
499
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500500* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200501 processes, separated by semicolons.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 CLI, separated by semicolons.
505
506See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200507
5082.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200509----------------
510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100511Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100512values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
513otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
514numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
515for every keyword. Supported units are :
516
517 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
518 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
519 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
520 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
521 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
522 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
523
524
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005252.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200526-------------
527
528 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
529 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
530 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
531 global
532 daemon
533 maxconn 256
534
535 defaults
536 mode http
537 timeout connect 5000ms
538 timeout client 50000ms
539 timeout server 50000ms
540
541 frontend http-in
542 bind *:80
543 default_backend servers
544
545 backend servers
546 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
547
548
549 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
550 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
551 global
552 daemon
553 maxconn 256
554
555 defaults
556 mode http
557 timeout connect 5000ms
558 timeout client 50000ms
559 timeout server 50000ms
560
561 listen http-in
562 bind *:80
563 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
564
565
566Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
567
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100568 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200569
570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005713. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572--------------------
573
574Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
575are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
576of them have command-line equivalents.
577
578The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
579
580 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200581 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200583 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - description
587 - deviceatlas-json-file
588 - deviceatlas-log-level
589 - deviceatlas-separator
590 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900591 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - gid
593 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100594 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200595 - h1-case-adjust
596 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100597 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100598 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200599 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200600 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100601 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200602 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200603 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200605 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100608 - presetenv
609 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - uid
611 - ulimit-n
612 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200613 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100614 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200615 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200617 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200618 - ssl-default-bind-options
619 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200620 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200621 - ssl-default-server-options
622 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100623 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100624 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100625 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100626 - 51degrees-data-file
627 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200628 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200629 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200630 - wurfl-data-file
631 - wurfl-information-list
632 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200633 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100634 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100635
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100637 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200638 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200639 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200640 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100641 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100642 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100643 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200644 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200645 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200646 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200647 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 - noepoll
649 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000650 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200651 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300653 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000654 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100655 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200656 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200657 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200658 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000659 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000660 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200661 - tune.buffers.limit
662 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200663 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200664 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100665 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200666 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200667 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200668 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100669 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200670 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200671 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100672 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100673 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100674 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100675 - tune.lua.session-timeout
676 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200677 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100678 - tune.maxaccept
679 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200680 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200681 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200682 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100683 - tune.rcvbuf.client
684 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100685 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200686 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100687 - tune.sndbuf.client
688 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100689 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100690 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200691 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100692 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200693 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200694 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100695 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200696 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100697 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200698 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
699 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
700 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100701 - tune.zlib.memlevel
702 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704 * Debugging
705 - debug
706 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200707
708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007093.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200710------------------------------------
711
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200712ca-base <dir>
713 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200714 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
715 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200716
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200717chroot <jail dir>
718 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
719 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
720 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
721 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
722 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100723 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100724
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100725cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
726 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
727 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
728 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
729 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
730 set. These sets have the format
731
732 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
733
734 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100735 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100736 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
737 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100738 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
739 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100740 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100741 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100743 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100744 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
745 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
746 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
747 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100748
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100749 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
750 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
751 on the machine's word size.
752
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100753 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100754 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
755 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
756 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
757 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
758 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
759 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100760
761 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100762 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
763
764 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
765 # first 4 CPUs
766
767 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
768 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
769 # word size.
770
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100771 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100772 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100773 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
774 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
775 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
776
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100777 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
778 # and so on.
779 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
780 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
781 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
782
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100783 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100784 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
785 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
786 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
787
788 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
789 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
790 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
791
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100792 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
793 # and a thread range.
794 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
795 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
796 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
797
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200798crt-base <dir>
799 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
800 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
801 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
802
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200803daemon
804 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
805 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100806 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
807 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200808
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200809deviceatlas-json-file <path>
810 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100811 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200812
813deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100814 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200815 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
816
817deviceatlas-separator <char>
818 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
819 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
820
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100821deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200822 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
823 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
824 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100825
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900826external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100827 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
828 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100829 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
830 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
831 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
832 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
833 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900834
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200835gid <number>
836 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
837 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
838 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100839 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
840 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200841 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100842
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100843group <group name>
844 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
845 See also "gid" and "user".
846
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100847hard-stop-after <time>
848 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
849
850 Arguments :
851 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
852 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
853 SIGUSR1 signal.
854
855 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
856 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
857 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
858
859 Example:
860 global
861 hard-stop-after 30s
862
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200863h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
864 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
865 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
866 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
867 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
868 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
869 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
870 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
871 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
872 specified in a proxy.
873
874 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
875 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
876 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
877 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
878 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
879 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
880 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
881
882 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
883 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
884 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
885 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
886 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
887
888 Example:
889 global
890 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
891
892 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
893 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
894
895h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
896 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
897 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
898 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
899 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
900 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
901 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
902 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
903 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
904
905 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
906 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
907 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
908
909 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
910 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
911
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100912insecure-fork-wanted
913 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
914 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
915 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
916 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
917 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
918 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
919 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
920 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
921 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
922 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
923 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
924 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
925 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
926 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
927 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
928 disable it.
929
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100930insecure-setuid-wanted
931 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
932 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
933 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
934 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
935 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
936 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
937 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
938 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
939 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
940 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
941 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
942 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
943 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
944 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
945
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200946log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
947 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100948 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100949 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100950 configured with "log global".
951
952 <address> can be one of:
953
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100954 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100955 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
956 port).
957
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100958 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
959 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
960 port).
961
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100962 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100963 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
964 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100965 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100966
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100967 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
968 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
969 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
970 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
971 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
972 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
973 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
974 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
975 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
976 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
977 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
978 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
979 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
980 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100981 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
982 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100983
984 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
985 "fd@2", see above.
986
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200987 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
988 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
989 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
990 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
991 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
992
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200993 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
994 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100995
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200996 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
997 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
998 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
999 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1000 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1001 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1002 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1003 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1004 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1005 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001006 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1007 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001008
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001009 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1010 one of the following :
1011
1012 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1013 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1014
1015 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1016 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1017
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001018 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1019 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1020 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1021 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1022 logger consumes.
1023
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001024 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1025 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1026 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1027 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1028
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001029 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1030 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1031 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1032 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1033 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1034
1035 <sample_size>
1036 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1037 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1038 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1039 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1040 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1041
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001042 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001043
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001044 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1045 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1046 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1047
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001048 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1049 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1050 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1051 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001052
1053 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001054 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1055 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1056 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1057 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1058 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1059 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001060
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001061 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001062
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001063log-send-hostname [<string>]
1064 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1065 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1066 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1067 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1068 the logs.
1069
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001070log-tag <string>
1071 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1072 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1073 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001074 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001075
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001076lua-load <file>
1077 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1078 used multiple times.
1079
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001080master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001081 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1082 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1083 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001084 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001085 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1086 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001087 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1088 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1089 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1090 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1091 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001092
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001093 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001094
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001095mworker-max-reloads <number>
1096 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001097 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001098 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1099 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1100 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1101
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001102nbproc <number>
1103 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1104 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1105 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001106 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1107 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001108 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1109 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001111nbthread <number>
1112 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001113 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1114 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1115 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1116 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1117 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001118 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1119 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1120 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1121 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1122 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1123 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1124 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001125
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001126pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001127 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001128 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1129 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1130
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001131presetenv <name> <value>
1132 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1133 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1134 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1135 and "unsetenv".
1136
1137resetenv [<name> ...]
1138 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1139 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1140 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1141 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1142 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1143 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1144 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1145 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1146
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001147stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001148 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1149 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1150 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1151 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1152 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1153 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001154 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001155 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1156 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1157 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1158 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001159
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001160server-state-base <directory>
1161 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001162 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1163 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001164
1165server-state-file <file>
1166 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1167 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1168 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1169 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1170 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1171 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1172 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1173 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001174 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1175 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001176
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001177setenv <name> <value>
1178 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1179 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1180 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1181 and "unsetenv".
1182
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001183set-dumpable
1184 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001185 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1186 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1187 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1188 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1189 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1190 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1191 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1192 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1193 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1194 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1195 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1196 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1197 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1198 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1199 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1200 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1201 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001202
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001203ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1204 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1205 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001206 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001207 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001208 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1209 information and recommendations see e.g.
1210 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1211 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1212 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1213 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001214
1215ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1216 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1217 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1218 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1219 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1220 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001221 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1222 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1223 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001224 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001225
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001226ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1227 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1228 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1229 keyword to see available options.
1230
1231 Example:
1232 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001233 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001234
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001235ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1236 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1237 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001238 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001239 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001240 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1241 information and recommendations see e.g.
1242 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1243 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1244 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1245 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1246 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001247
1248ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1249 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1250 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1251 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1252 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1253 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001254 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1255 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1256 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1257 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001258
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001259ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1260 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1261 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1262 keyword to see available options.
1263
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001264ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1266 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1267 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001268 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001269 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001270 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1271 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1272 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1273 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001274 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1275 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1276 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1277
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001278ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1279 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1280 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1281 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1282
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001283stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1284 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1285 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1286 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001287 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001288 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001289
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001290 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1291 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1292 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001293
1294stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1295 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1296 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001297 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001298
1299stats maxconn <connections>
1300 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1301 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1302
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001303uid <number>
1304 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1305 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1306 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1307 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1308
1309ulimit-n <number>
1310 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1311 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1312 option.
1313
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001314unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1315 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1316
1317 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1318 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1319 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1320 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1321 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1322 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1323 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1324 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1325 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1326 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1327
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001328unsetenv [<name> ...]
1329 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1330 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1331 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1332 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1333 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1334 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1335 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1336
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001337user <user name>
1338 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1339 See also "uid" and "group".
1340
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001341node <name>
1342 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1343
1344 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1345 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1346 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1347 traffic.
1348
1349description <text>
1350 Add a text that describes the instance.
1351
1352 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1353 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1354 "<" and ">" characters.
1355
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100135651degrees-data-file <file path>
1357 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001358 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001359
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001360 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001361 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1362
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000136351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001364 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1365 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1366 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1367
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001368 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001369 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1370
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200137151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001372 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1373 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1374
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001375 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1376 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1377
137851degrees-cache-size <number>
1379 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1380 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1381 By default, this cache is disabled.
1382
1383 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001384 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1385
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001386wurfl-data-file <file path>
1387 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1388 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1389
1390 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1391 with USE_WURFL=1.
1392
1393wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1394 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1395 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1396 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1397
1398 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1399
1400 Valid WURFL properties are:
1401 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1402
1403 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1404 device.
1405
1406 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1407 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1408
1409 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1410 particular web request.
1411
1412 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1413 used Libwurfl API version.
1414
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001415 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1416 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1417
1418 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1419 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1420
1421 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1422
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001423 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1424 with USE_WURFL=1.
1425
1426wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1427 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1428 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1429
1430 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1431 with USE_WURFL=1.
1432
1433wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1434 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1435 thus before the chroot.
1436
1437 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1438 with USE_WURFL=1.
1439
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001440wurfl-cache-size <size>
1441 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1442 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001443 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001444 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001445
1446 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1447 with USE_WURFL=1.
1448
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001449strict-limits
1450 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1451 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1452 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1453 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1454 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1455 keyword.
1456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014573.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001458-----------------------
1459
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001460busy-polling
1461 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1462 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1463 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1464 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1465 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1466 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1467 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1468 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1469 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1470 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1471 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1472 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1473 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1474 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1475 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1476 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1477 "poll" pollers.
1478
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001479max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1480 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1481 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1482 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1483 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1484 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1485 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1486 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1487 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1488
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001489maxconn <number>
1490 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1491 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1492 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001493 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1494 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1495 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1496 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001497 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1498 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1499 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1500 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1501 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1502 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001503
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001504maxconnrate <number>
1505 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1506 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1507 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1508 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1509 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1510 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1511 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1512 fairness.
1513
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001514maxcomprate <number>
1515 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001516 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001517 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1518 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1519 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001520 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001521 default value.
1522
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001523maxcompcpuusage <number>
1524 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1525 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1526 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1527 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1528 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1529 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1530 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1531 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1532
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001533maxpipes <number>
1534 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1535 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1536 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1537 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1538 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1539 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1540
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001541maxsessrate <number>
1542 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1543 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1544 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1545 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1546 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1547 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1548 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1549 fairness.
1550
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001551maxsslconn <number>
1552 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1553 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1554 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1555 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1556 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1557 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1558 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001559 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1560 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1561 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1562 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1563 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1564 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1565 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001566
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001567maxsslrate <number>
1568 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1569 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1570 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1571 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1572 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1573 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1574 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1575 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1576 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1577 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1578
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001579maxzlibmem <number>
1580 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1581 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1582 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001583 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1584 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1585 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1586
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001587noepoll
1588 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1589 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001590 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001591
1592nokqueue
1593 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1594 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1595 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1596
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001597noevports
1598 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1599 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1600 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1601 also "nopoll".
1602
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001603nopoll
1604 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1605 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001606 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001607 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1608 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001609
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001610nosplice
1611 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001612 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001613 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001614 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001615 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1616 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1617 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1618 "option splice-response".
1619
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001620nogetaddrinfo
1621 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1622 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1623
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001624noreuseport
1625 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1626 command line argument "-dR".
1627
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001628profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1629 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1630 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1631 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1632 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001633 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001634 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1635 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1636 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1637 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1638
1639 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1640 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1641 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1642 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1643 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001644 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1645 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1646 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1647 CLI.
1648
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001649spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001650 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1651 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1652 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1653 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1654 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1655 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001656
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001657ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001658 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001659 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001660 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1661 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1662 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1663 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1664 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001665 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1666 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001667 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1668 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1669 openssl configuration file uses:
1670 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1671
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001672ssl-mode-async
1673 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001674 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001675 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1676 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1677 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001678 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001679 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001680
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001681tune.buffers.limit <number>
1682 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1683 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1684 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1685 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1686 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001687 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001688 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1689 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1690 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1691 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1692 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1693 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1694 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1695 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1696 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1697
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001698tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1699 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1700 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1701 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1702 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1703
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001704tune.bufsize <number>
1705 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1706 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1707 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1708 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1709 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1710 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1711 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001712 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1713 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1714 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001715 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001716 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1717 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1718 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001719
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001720tune.chksize <number>
1721 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1722 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1723 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1724 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1725 checks whenever possible.
1726
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001727tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1728 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1729 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1730 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1731 this value. The default value is 1.
1732
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001733tune.fail-alloc
1734 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1735 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1736 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1737 gracefully.
1738
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001739tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1740 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1741 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1742 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1743 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1744 change it.
1745
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001746tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1747 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001748 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1749 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001750 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1751 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1752 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1753 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1754 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1755
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001756tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1757 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1758 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1759 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1760 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1761 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1762 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1763 recommended not to change this value.
1764
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001765tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1766 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1767 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1768 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1769 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1770 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1771 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1772 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1773
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001774tune.http.cookielen <number>
1775 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1776 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1777 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1778 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1779 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1780 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1781 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1782 to change this value.
1783
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001784tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001785 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1786 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001787 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001788 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001789 configuration directives too.
1790 The default value is 1024.
1791
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001792tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1793 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1794 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1795 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1796 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1797 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1798 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001799 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1800 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1801 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001802
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001803tune.idletimer <timeout>
1804 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1805 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1806 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1807 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1808 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1809 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001810 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001811 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001812 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1813
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001814tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1815 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1816 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1817 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1818 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1819 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1820 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1821 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1822 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1823 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1824
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001825tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1826 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001827 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001828 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1829 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001830 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001831 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1832 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1833
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001834tune.lua.maxmem
1835 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1836 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1837 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1838 memory.
1839
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001840tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1841 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001842 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1843 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001844 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001845
1846tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1847 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1848 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1849 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1850 check servers.
1851
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001852tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1853 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1854 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1855 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001856 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001857
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001858tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001859 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1860 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1861 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1862 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1863 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1864 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1865 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1866 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1867 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1868 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001869
1870tune.maxpollevents <number>
1871 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1872 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1873 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1874 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1875 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1876
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001877tune.maxrewrite <number>
1878 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1879 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1880 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1881 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1882 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1883 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1884 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1885 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1886 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1887 bufsize.
1888
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001889tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1890 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1891 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1892 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1893 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1894 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1895 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1896 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1897 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1898 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001899 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1900 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001901 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1902 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1903 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1904 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1905 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1906 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1907 setting this parameter to 0.
1908
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001909tune.pipesize <number>
1910 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1911 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1912 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1913 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1914 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1915 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1916
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001917tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1918 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1919 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1920 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1921 default is 20.
1922
1923tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1924 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1925 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1926 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1927 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1928 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1929 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001930 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001931
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001932tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1933tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1934 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1935 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1936 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001937 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001938 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001939 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1940 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1941
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001942tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001943 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001944 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1945 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1946 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1947 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1948
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001949tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001950 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001951 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1952 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1953
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001954tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1955tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1956 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1957 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1958 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001959 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001960 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001961 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1962 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1963 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1964 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1965 notifying haproxy again.
1966
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001967tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001968 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1969 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1970 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001971 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001972 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001973 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001974 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1975 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1976 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001977 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1978 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001979
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001980tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001981 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001982 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1983 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1984 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1985 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1986 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1987
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001988tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1989 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001990 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001991 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1992 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1993 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1994 being used for too long.
1995
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001996tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1997 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1998 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1999 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2000 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2001 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2002 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2003 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2004 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2005 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2006 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002007 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002008 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002009
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002010tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2011 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2012 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2013 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2014 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2015 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2016 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2017 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002018 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2019 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002020
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002021tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2022 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2023 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2024 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2025 1000 entries.
2026
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002027tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2028 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2029 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2030 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2031
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002032tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002033tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002034tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2035tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2036tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002037 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2038 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2039 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2040 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2041 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2042 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2043 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2044 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002045
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002046 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2047 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2048 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2049 all available space is consumed.
2050 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2051 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2052 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002053
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002054tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2055 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002056 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002057 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002058 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002059 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2060
2061tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2062 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2063 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002064 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2065 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020673.3. Debugging
2068--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002069
2070debug
2071 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2072 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2073 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2074 system startup.
2075
2076quiet
2077 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2078 line argument "-q".
2079
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002080
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020813.4. Userlists
2082--------------
2083It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2084http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2085it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2086
2087userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002088 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002089 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2090
2091group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002092 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002093 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2094 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2095
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002096user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2097 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002098 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2099 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002100 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2101 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2102 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2103 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002104
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002105 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2106 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2107 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2108 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2109 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2110 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2111 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2112 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2113 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002114
2115 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002116 userlist L1
2117 group G1 users tiger,scott
2118 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002119
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002120 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2121 user scott insecure-password elgato
2122 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002123
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002124 userlist L2
2125 group G1
2126 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002127
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002128 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2129 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2130 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002131
2132 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002133
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002134
21353.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002136----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002137It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2138several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2139instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2140values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2141automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2142In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2143using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2144tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2145reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2146Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2147that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2148each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002149
2150peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002151 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002152 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2153
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002154bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2155 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2156 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2157
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002158disabled
2159 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2160 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2161 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2162
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002163default-bind [param*]
2164 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2165
2166default-server [param*]
2167 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2168
2169 Arguments:
2170 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2171 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2172 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2173 details.
2174
2175
2176 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2177
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002178enable
2179 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2180
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002181log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2182 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2183 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2184 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2185 more details.
2186
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002187peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002188 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2189 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2190 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2191 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2192 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2193 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2194
2195 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2196 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2197
2198 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2199 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2200 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2201 across all peers.
2202
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002203 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2204 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002205
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002206 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2207 "server" keyword explanation below).
2208
2209server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002210 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002211 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2212 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2213 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2214 of this "peers" section).
2215 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2216
2217
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002218 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002219 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002220 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002221 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2222 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2223 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002224
2225 backend mybackend
2226 mode tcp
2227 balance roundrobin
2228 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2229 stick on src
2230
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002231 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2232 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002233
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002234 Example:
2235 peers mypeers
2236 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2237 default-server ssl verify none
2238 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2239 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002240
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002241
2242table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2243 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2244
2245 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2246 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002247 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002248 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2249 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2250 "stick-table" keyword).
2251
2252 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2253 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2254 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2255 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2256 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2257 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2258 of the stick-table name as follows:
2259
2260 peers mypeers
2261 peer A ...
2262 peer B ...
2263 table t1 ...
2264
2265 frontend fe1
2266 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2267
2268 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2269 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2270
2271 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2272 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2273 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2274 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2275 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2276 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2277 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2278
2279 peers mypeers
2280 peer A ...
2281 peer B ...
2282 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2283
2284 backend t1
2285 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2286
2287 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2288 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2289 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2290
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022913.6. Mailers
2292------------
2293It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2294If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2295in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2296
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002297mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002298 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2299 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2300
2301mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2302 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2303
2304 Example:
2305 mailers mymailers
2306 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2307 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2308
2309 backend mybackend
2310 mode tcp
2311 balance roundrobin
2312
2313 email-alert mailers mymailers
2314 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2315 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2316
2317 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2318 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2319
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002320timeout mail <time>
2321 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2322 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2323 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2324 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2325
2326 Example:
2327 mailers mymailers
2328 timeout mail 20s
2329 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002330
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020023313.7. Programs
2332-------------
2333In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2334master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2335managed the same way as the workers.
2336
2337During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2338sequence as a worker:
2339
2340 - the master is re-executed
2341 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2342 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2343 instance of the program
2344
2345During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2346
2347program <name>
2348 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2349 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2350 the management guide).
2351
2352command <command> [arguments*]
2353 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2354 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2355 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2356 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2357
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002358user <user name>
2359 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2360 See also "group".
2361
2362group <group name>
2363 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2364 See also "user".
2365
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002366option start-on-reload
2367no option start-on-reload
2368 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2369 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2370 program section.
2371
2372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023734. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002374----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002375
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002376Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002377 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002378 - frontend <name>
2379 - backend <name>
2380 - listen <name>
2381
2382A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2383its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2384section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002385section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002386
2387A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2388connections.
2389
2390A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2391to forward incoming connections.
2392
2393A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2394parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002396All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2397'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2398case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2399
2400Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2401logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2402proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2403However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2404name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2405
2406Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2407and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002408bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002409protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2410modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2411arbitrary criteria.
2412
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002413In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2414a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002415the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002416
2417 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2418 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2419 between responses and new requests.
2420
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002421 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2422 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2423 client-facing connection remains open.
2424
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002425 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2426 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002427
2428The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2429frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2430following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002431weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002432
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002433 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002434
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002435 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2436 ----+-----+-----+----
2437 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2438 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002439 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2440 ----+-----+-----+----
2441 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002442
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002443
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024454.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2446--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002448The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2449limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2450they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2451limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002452marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002453option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002454and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2455with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2456specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002457
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002458
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002459 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2460------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2461acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002462backlog X X X -
2463balance X - X X
2464bind - X X -
2465bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002466capture cookie - X X -
2467capture request header - X X -
2468capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002469compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002470cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002471declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002472default-server X - X X
2473default_backend X X X -
2474description - X X X
2475disabled X X X X
2476dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002477email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002478email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002479email-alert mailers X X X X
2480email-alert myhostname X X X X
2481email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002482enabled X X X X
2483errorfile X X X X
2484errorloc X X X X
2485errorloc302 X X X X
2486-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2487errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002488force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002489filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002490fullconn X - X X
2491grace X X X X
2492hash-type X - X X
2493http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002494http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002495http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002496http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002497http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002498http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002499http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002500id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002501ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002502load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002503log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002504log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002505log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002506log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002507max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002508maxconn X X X -
2509mode X X X X
2510monitor fail - X X -
2511monitor-net X X X -
2512monitor-uri X X X -
2513option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2514option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2515option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2516option allbackups (*) X - X X
2517option checkcache (*) X - X X
2518option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2519option contstats (*) X X X -
2520option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2521option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002522-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2523option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002524option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2525option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002526option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002527option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002528option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002529option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002530option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002531option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2532option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2533option httpchk X - X X
2534option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002535option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002536option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002537option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002538option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002539option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002540option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2541option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2542option logasap (*) X X X -
2543option mysql-check X - X X
2544option nolinger (*) X X X X
2545option originalto X X X X
2546option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002547option pgsql-check X - X X
2548option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002549option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002550option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002551option smtpchk X - X X
2552option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2553option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2554option splice-request (*) X X X X
2555option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002556option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002557option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2558option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2559-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002560option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002561option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2562option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2563option tcpka X X X X
2564option tcplog X X X X
2565option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002566external-check command X - X X
2567external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002568persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2569rate-limit sessions X X X -
2570redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002571-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002572retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002573retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002574server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002575server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002576server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002577source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002578stats admin - X X X
2579stats auth X X X X
2580stats enable X X X X
2581stats hide-version X X X X
2582stats http-request - X X X
2583stats realm X X X X
2584stats refresh X X X X
2585stats scope X X X X
2586stats show-desc X X X X
2587stats show-legends X X X X
2588stats show-node X X X X
2589stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002590-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2591stick match - - X X
2592stick on - - X X
2593stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002594stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002595stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002596tcp-check connect - - X X
2597tcp-check expect - - X X
2598tcp-check send - - X X
2599tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002600tcp-request connection - X X -
2601tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002602tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002603tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002604tcp-response content - - X X
2605tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002606timeout check X - X X
2607timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002608timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002609timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002610timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2611timeout http-request X X X X
2612timeout queue X - X X
2613timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002614timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002615timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002616timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002617transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002618unique-id-format X X X -
2619unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002620use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002621use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002622use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002623------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2624 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002625
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026274.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2628---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002629
2630This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2631
2632
2633acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2634 Declare or complete an access list.
2635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2636 no | yes | yes | yes
2637 Example:
2638 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2639 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2640 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002642 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002643
2644
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002645backlog <conns>
2646 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2648 yes | yes | yes | no
2649 Arguments :
2650 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2651 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002652 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002653
2654 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2655 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2656 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2657 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2658 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2659 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2660 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2661 backlog parameter.
2662
2663 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2664 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2665 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2666
2667 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2668
2669
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002670balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002671balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002672 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2674 yes | no | yes | yes
2675 Arguments :
2676 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2677 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2678 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2679 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2680
2681 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2682 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2683 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2684 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002685 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002686 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002687 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2688 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2689 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2690 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2691 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2692 it, so that you don't worry.
2693
2694 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2695 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2696 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2697 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2698 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2699 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2700 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2701 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002702
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002703 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2704 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2705 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2706 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2707 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2708 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2709 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2710 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2711
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002712 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002713 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002714 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2715 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002716 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002717 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2718 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2719 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2720 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2721 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002722 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2723 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2724 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2725 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2726 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2727 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002728
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002729 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2730 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2731 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2732 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2733 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2734 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2735 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2736 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002737 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002738 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002739 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2740 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2741 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002742
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002743 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2744 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2745 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2746 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2747 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2748 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2749 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2750 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2751 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2752 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2753 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2754 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002755
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002756 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002757 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2758 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2759 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2760 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2761 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2762 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2763 URIs start with a leading "/".
2764
2765 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2766 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2767 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2768 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2769
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002770 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002771 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2772
2773 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002774 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2775 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002776 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2777 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2778 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2779 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002780 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002781 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2782 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002783
2784 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2785 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2786 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2787 server will receive the request.
2788
2789 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2790 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2791 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2792 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2793 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002794 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2795 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2796 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002797
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002798 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2799 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2800 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2801 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2802 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002803
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002804 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002805 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2806 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2807 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2808
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002809 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2810 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2811 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2812
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002813 random
2814 random(<draws>)
2815 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002816 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2817 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2818 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2819 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002820 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2821 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2822 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2823 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2824 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2825 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2826 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2827 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2828 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2829 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2830 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2831 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2832 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2833 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2834 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2835 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2836 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2837 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2838 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2839 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002840
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002841 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002842 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002843 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2844 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2845 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2846 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2847 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2848 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002849 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002850 used instead.
2851
2852 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2853 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2854 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2855 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2856
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002857 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2858 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2859 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2860
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002861 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002862
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002863 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002864 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2865 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002866
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002867 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2868 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2869 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002870
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002871 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002872 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002873 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2874 NTLM relies on.
2875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002876 Examples :
2877 balance roundrobin
2878 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002879 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002880 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2881 balance hdr(host)
2882 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002883
2884 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2885 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002887 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002888 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2889 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2890 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02002891 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002892
2893 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2894 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2895 defaults to 16 kB.
2896
2897 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2898 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2899
2900 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2901 Round Robin.
2902
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002903 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002904 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2905 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2906 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2907
2908 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2909
2910 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002911 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002912 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2913 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2914 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002915
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002916 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917
2918
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002919bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2920bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002921 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2923 no | yes | yes | no
2924 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002925 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2926 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2927 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2928 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002929 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002930 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2931 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2932 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2933 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2934 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2935 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2936 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002937 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2938 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2939 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2940 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2941 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2942 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2943 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002944 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2945 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2946 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002947 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2948 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2949 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2950 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002951 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2952 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2953 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002954
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002955 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2956 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002957 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2958 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2959 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002960 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2961 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2962 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2963 the range.
2964
2965 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2966 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2967 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2968 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2969 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2970 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2971 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002972 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002973 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002974
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002975 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002976 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002977 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2978 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2979 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2980 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2981 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2982 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2983
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002984 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2985 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2986 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2987 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002988
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002989 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2990 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2991 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2992 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2993 in a frontend.
2994
2995 Example :
2996 listen http_proxy
2997 bind :80,:443
2998 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002999 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003000
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003001 listen http_https_proxy
3002 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003003 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003004
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003005 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3006 bind ipv6@:80
3007 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3008 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3009
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003010 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003011 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003012
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003013 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3014 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3015 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3016 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3017 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3018
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003019 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003020 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003021
3022
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003023bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003024 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3026 yes | yes | yes | yes
3027 Arguments :
3028 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3029 may be used to override a default value.
3030
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003031 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003032 option may be combined with other numbers.
3033
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003034 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003035 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3036 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3037 missing from all processes.
3038
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003039 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003040 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003041 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3042 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3043 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3044 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3045 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003046 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003047
3048 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3049 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3050 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3051 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3052 and 'even' instances.
3053
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003054 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3055 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3056 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3057 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003058
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003059 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3060 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3061
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003062 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3063 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3064 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3065
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003066 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3067 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3068
3069 Example :
3070 listen app_ip1
3071 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003072 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003073
3074 listen app_ip2
3075 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003076 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003077
3078 listen management
3079 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003080 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003081
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003082 listen management
3083 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3084 bind-process 1-4
3085
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003086 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003087
3088
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003089capture cookie <name> len <length>
3090 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3092 no | yes | yes | no
3093 Arguments :
3094 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3095 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3096 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3097 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003098 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003099
3100 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3101 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3102 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3103 right if it exceeds <length>.
3104
3105 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3106 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3107 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3108 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3109
3110 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3111 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3112 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3113
3114 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3115 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3116 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003117 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3118 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3119 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003120
3121 Example:
3122 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3123
3124 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003125 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003126
3127
3128capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003129 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3131 no | yes | yes | no
3132 Arguments :
3133 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003134 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003135 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3136 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3137 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3138
3139 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3140 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3141 it exceeds <length>.
3142
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003143 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003144 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3145 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003146 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3147 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3148 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3149 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003150 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003151 environments to find where the request came from.
3152
3153 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3154 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3155 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3156 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003157
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003158 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3159 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3160 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3161 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3162 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003163
3164 Example:
3165 capture request header Host len 15
3166 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003167 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003169 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003170 about logging.
3171
3172
3173capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003174 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3176 no | yes | yes | no
3177 Arguments :
3178 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003179 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003180 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3181 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3182 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3183
3184 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3185 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3186 it exceeds <length>.
3187
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003188 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003189 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3190 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3191 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003192 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3193 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3194 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3195 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003196
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003197 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3198 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3199 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3200 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3201 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003202
3203 Example:
3204 capture response header Content-length len 9
3205 capture response header Location len 15
3206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003207 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003208 about logging.
3209
3210
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003211compression algo <algorithm> ...
3212compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003213compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003214 Enable HTTP compression.
3215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3216 yes | yes | yes | yes
3217 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003218 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3219 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3220 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3221
3222 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003223 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3224 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3225 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003226
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003227 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003228 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003229
3230 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3231 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3232 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3233 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3234 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003235 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003236
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003237 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3238 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3239 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3240 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3241 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3242 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3243 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003244 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003245
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003246 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003247 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003248 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3249 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3250 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3251 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3252 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003253
3254 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3255 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3256 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3257 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3258 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003259 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3260 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3261 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3262 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3263 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003264 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3265 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003266
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003267 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003268 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3269 "Accept-Encoding" header
3270 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003271 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003272 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3273 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3274 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3275 "multipart"
3276 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3277 header
3278 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3279 and later
3280 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3281 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003282 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003283
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003284 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003285
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003286 Examples :
3287 compression algo gzip
3288 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003289
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003290
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003291cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003292 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3293 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003294 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003295 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3297 yes | no | yes | yes
3298 Arguments :
3299 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3300 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3301 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3302 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3303 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3304 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003305 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3307 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3308
3309 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3310 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3311 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3312 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3313 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3314 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003315 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3316 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003317 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003318 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3319 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003320
3321 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003322 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003323
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003324 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003325 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003326 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003327 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003328 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3329 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3330 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3331 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3332 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3333 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3334 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003335
3336 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3337 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3338 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3339 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3340 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3341 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3342 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3343 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3344 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003345 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003346 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3347 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3348 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003349
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003350 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3351 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3352 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003353 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3354 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3355 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3356 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003357 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3358 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3359 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003360
3361 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3362 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3363 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3364 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3365 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3366 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3367 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3368 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3369 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3370
3371 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3372 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3373 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3374 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3375 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3376 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3377 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3378 persistence cookie in the cache.
3379 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3380
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003381 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3382 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3383 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3384 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3385 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003386 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003387 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3388 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3389 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3390 they logout.
3391
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003392 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3393 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3394 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3395 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3396
3397 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3398 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3399 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3400 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3401 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3402 this attribute.
3403
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003404 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003405 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003406 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3407 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3408 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3409 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3410 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3411 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003412
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003413 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3414 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3415 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3416 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3417 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3418 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3419 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3420 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003421 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003422 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3423 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3424 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3425 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3426 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3427 the site.
3428
3429 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3430 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3431 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3432 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3433 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3434 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3435 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3436 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3437 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3438 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3439 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3440 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3441 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003442 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003443 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3444 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3445
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003446 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3447 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3448 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3449 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3450 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3451 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3452
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003453 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3454 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3455 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3456 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003457
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003458 Examples :
3459 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3460 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3461 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003462 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003463
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003464 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003466
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003467declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3468 Declares a capture slot.
3469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3470 no | yes | yes | no
3471 Arguments:
3472 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3473
3474 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3475 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3476 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3477 for use in the response.
3478
3479 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003480 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003481 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3482
3483
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003484default-server [param*]
3485 Change default options for a server in a backend
3486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3487 yes | no | yes | yes
3488 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003489 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3490 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3491 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3492 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003493
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003494 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003495 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3496
3497 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003498
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003499
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003500default_backend <backend>
3501 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3503 yes | yes | yes | no
3504 Arguments :
3505 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3506
3507 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3508 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3509 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3510 will catch all undetermined requests.
3511
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003512 Example :
3513
3514 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3515 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3516 default_backend dynamic
3517
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003518 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003519
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003520
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003521description <string>
3522 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3524 no | yes | yes | yes
3525 Arguments : string
3526
3527 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3528 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3529 it describes.
3530 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3531
3532
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003533disabled
3534 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3536 yes | yes | yes | yes
3537 Arguments : none
3538
3539 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3540 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3541 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3542 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3543 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3544 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3545 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3546
3547 See also : "enabled"
3548
3549
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003550dispatch <address>:<port>
3551 Set a default server address
3552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3553 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003554 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003555
3556 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3557 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3558 during start-up.
3559
3560 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3561 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3562 possible with normal servers.
3563
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003564 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003565 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3566 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3567 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3568 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3569
3570 See also : "server"
3571
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003572
3573dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3574 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3576 yes | no | yes | yes
3577 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3578
3579 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003580 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003581 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3582 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003583 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003584 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003585
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003586enabled
3587 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3589 yes | yes | yes | yes
3590 Arguments : none
3591
3592 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3593 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3594
3595 See also : "disabled"
3596
3597
3598errorfile <code> <file>
3599 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3601 yes | yes | yes | yes
3602 Arguments :
3603 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003604 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3605 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003606
3607 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003608 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003609 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003610 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3611 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003612
3613 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3614 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3615 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3616
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003617 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3618
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003619 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3620 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3621 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3622 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3623
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003624 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3625 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003626 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003627 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3628 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3629 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3630
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003631 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3632 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3633 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003634 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003635 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3636
3637 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3638
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003639 Example :
3640 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003641 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003642 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3643 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3644
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003645
3646errorloc <code> <url>
3647errorloc302 <code> <url>
3648 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3650 yes | yes | yes | yes
3651 Arguments :
3652 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003653 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3654 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003655
3656 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3657 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3658 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3659 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003660 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003661
3662 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3663 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3664 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3665
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003666 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3667
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003668 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3669 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3670 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3671 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003672 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003673 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3674 request.
3675
3676 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3677
3678
3679errorloc303 <code> <url>
3680 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3682 yes | yes | yes | yes
3683 Arguments :
3684 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003685 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3686 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003687
3688 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3689 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3690 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3691 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003692 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003693
3694 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3695 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3696 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3697
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003698 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3699
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003700 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3701 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3702 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3703 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003704 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003705
3706 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3707
3708
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003709email-alert from <emailaddr>
3710 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003711 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003712 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3713 yes | yes | yes | yes
3714
3715 Arguments :
3716
3717 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3718
3719 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3720 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3721
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003722 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003723 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3724 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003725
3726
3727email-alert level <level>
3728 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3729 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3730 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3731 yes | yes | yes | yes
3732
3733 Arguments :
3734
3735 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3736 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3737 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3738
3739 By default level is alert
3740
3741 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3742 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3743 for the proxy.
3744
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003745 Alerts are sent when :
3746
3747 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3748 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3749 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3750 is notice or lower
3751 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3752 and a health check status update occurs
3753
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003754 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3755 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003756 section 3.6 about mailers.
3757
3758
3759email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3760 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3761 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3762 yes | yes | yes | yes
3763
3764 Arguments :
3765
3766 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3767
3768 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3769 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3770
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003771 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3772 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003773
3774
3775email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3776 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3777 mailers.
3778 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3779 yes | yes | yes | yes
3780
3781 Arguments :
3782
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003783 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003784
3785 By default the systems hostname is used.
3786
3787 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3788 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3789 for the proxy.
3790
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003791 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3792 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003793
3794
3795email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003796 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003797 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3798 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3799 yes | yes | yes | yes
3800
3801 Arguments :
3802
3803 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3804
3805 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3806 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3807
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003808 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003809 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3810
3811
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003812force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3813 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3814 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003815 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003816
3817 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3818 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3819 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3820 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3821 marked down for maintenance operations.
3822
3823 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3824 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3825 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3826 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3827 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3828 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3829 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3830 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3831 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3832
3833 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3834 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3835 is used.
3836
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003837 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003838 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003839
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003840
3841filter <name> [param*]
3842 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3844 no | yes | yes | yes
3845 Arguments :
3846 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3847 referenced in section 9.
3848
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003849 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003850 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003851 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3852 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003853
3854 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3855 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3856
3857 Example:
3858 listen
3859 bind *:80
3860
3861 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3862 filter compression
3863 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3864
3865 compression algo gzip
3866 compression offload
3867
3868 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3869
3870 See also : section 9.
3871
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003872
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003873fullconn <conns>
3874 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3876 yes | no | yes | yes
3877 Arguments :
3878 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3879 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3880
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003881 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003882 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003883 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003884 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3885 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3886 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3887 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3888 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003889 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003890
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003891 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3892 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003893 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3894 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3895 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003896
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003897 Example :
3898 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3899 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3900 # connections.
3901 backend dynamic
3902 fullconn 10000
3903 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3904 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3905
3906 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3907
3908
3909grace <time>
3910 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003912 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003913 Arguments :
3914 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3915 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3916 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3917
3918 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3919 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003920 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003921 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3922
3923 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3924 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3925 simplify it.
3926
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003927
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003928hash-balance-factor <factor>
3929 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3931 yes | no | no | yes
3932 Arguments :
3933 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3934 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003935 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003936
3937 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3938 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3939 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3940 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3941 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3942 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3943 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3944
3945 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3946 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3947 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3948 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3949 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3950
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003951 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3952 consistent hashing mechanism.
3953
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003954 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3955
3956
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003957hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003958 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3960 yes | no | yes | yes
3961 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003962 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3963 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003964
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003965 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3966 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3967 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3968 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3969 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3970 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3971 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3972 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3973 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3974 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003975
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003976 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3977 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3978 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3979 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3980 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3981 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3982 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3983 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3984 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3985 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3986 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3987 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3988 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003989 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3990 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003991
3992 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3993
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003994 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003995 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3996 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3997 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003998 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3999 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4000 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004001
4002 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4003 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004004 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4005 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4006 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4007 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4008
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004009 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4010 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4011 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4012 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4013 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4014 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4015 parameter.
4016
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004017 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4018 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4019 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4020 used on strings.
4021
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004022 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4023
4024 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4025 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4026 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4027 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4028 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4029 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4030 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4031 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4032 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4033 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4034 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4035 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004036
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004037 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4038 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4039 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004040
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004041 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004042
4043
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004044http-check disable-on-404
4045 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004047 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004048 Arguments : none
4049
4050 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4051 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4052 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4053 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4054 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4055 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4056 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4057 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004058 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4059 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4060 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4061
4062 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4063
4064
4065http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004066 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004068 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004069 Arguments :
4070 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4071 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004072 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004073 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4074 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4075 details on the supported keywords.
4076
4077 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4078 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4079 with the usual backslash ('\').
4080
4081 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4082 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4083 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4084 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4085 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4086
4087 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004088 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004089 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4090 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4091 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4092
4093 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004094 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004095 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4096 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4097 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4098 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4099
4100 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004101 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004102 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4103 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4104 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4105 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4106 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004107 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004108 trace).
4109
4110 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004111 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004112 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4113 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4114 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4115 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4116 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004117 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004118
4119 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4120 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4121 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4122 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4123 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4124 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4125 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4126 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4127
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004128 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4129 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4130 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4131
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004132 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4133 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4134
4135 Examples :
4136 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004137 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004138
4139 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004140 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004141
4142 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004143 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004144
4145 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004146 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004147
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004148 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004149
4150
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004151http-check send-state
4152 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4154 yes | no | yes | yes
4155 Arguments : none
4156
4157 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4158 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4159 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4160 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4161 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4162
4163 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4164 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4165 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4166 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4167 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004168 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4169 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4170 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4171
4172 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4173 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4174 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4175
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004176 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4177 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4178 checked in multiple backends.
4179
4180 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4181 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4182
4183 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4184 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4185 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4186 one fails.
4187
4188 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4189 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4190 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4191
4192 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4193 server's queue.
4194
4195 Example of a header received by the application server :
4196 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4197 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4198
4199 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4200
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004201
4202http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004203 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4204
4205 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4206 no | yes | yes | yes
4207
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004208 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4209 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4210 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4211 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4212 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004213
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004214 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4215 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004216
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004217 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004218
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004219 Example:
4220 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4221 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4222 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004223
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004224 http-request allow if nagios
4225 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4226 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4227 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004228
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004229 Example:
4230 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4231 acl add path /addacl
4232 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004233
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004234 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004235
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004236 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4237 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004238
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004239 Example:
4240 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4241 acl setmap path /setmap
4242 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004243
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004244 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004245
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004246 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4247 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004248
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004249 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4250 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004252http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004253
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004254 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4255 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4256 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4257 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4258 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4259 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4260 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4261 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004262
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004263http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004264
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004265 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4266 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4267 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4268 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4269 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4270 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4271 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4272 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004273
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004274http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004275
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004276 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4277 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004278
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004280http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004282 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4283 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4284 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4285 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4286 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004288 Example:
4289 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4290 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004291
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004292http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004293
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004294 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004295
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004296http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4297 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004299 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4300 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4301 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4302 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4303 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4304 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4305 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4306 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4307 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4310 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4311 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4312 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4313 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4314 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004316http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004317
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004318 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4319 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4320 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4321 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4322 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4323 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004325http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004327 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004329http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004331 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4332 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4333 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4334 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4335 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4336 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004338http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4341 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4342 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4343 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4344 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004345
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004346http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4347 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4348 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4349 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4350
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004351http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4352
4353 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4354 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4355 pointed by <resolvers>.
4356 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4357 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4358 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4359 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4360 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4361 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4362 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4363 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4364 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4365 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4366 to 0.0.0.0.
4367
4368 Example:
4369 resolvers mydns
4370 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4371 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4372 timeout retry 1s
4373 hold valid 10s
4374 hold nx 3s
4375 hold other 3s
4376 hold obsolete 0s
4377 accepted_payload_size 8192
4378
4379 frontend fe
4380 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4381 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4382 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4383
4384 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4385 # which mean DNS resolution error
4386 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4387
4388 default_backend be
4389
4390 backend b_503
4391 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4392 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4393 # 503 error page to end users
4394
4395 backend be
4396 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4397 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4398 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4399 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4400 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4401
4402 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4403 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4404
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004405http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4406
4407 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4408 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4409 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4410 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004411 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4412 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004413
4414 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4415
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004416http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004417
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004418 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4419 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4420 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4421 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4422 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004424http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004425
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004426 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4427 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4428 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4429 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004430
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004431http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4432 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004433
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004434 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4435 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4436 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4437 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4438 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4439 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004440
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004441 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4442 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4443 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4444 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4445 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004446
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004447 Example:
4448 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4449
4450 # applied to:
4451 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4452
4453 # outputs:
4454 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4455
4456 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004457
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004458 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4459
4460 # applied to:
4461 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004462
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004463 # outputs:
4464 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004465
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004466http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4467 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4468
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004469 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4470 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4471 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4472 against.
4473
4474 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4475 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4476 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004477
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004478 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4479 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4480 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4481 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4482 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4483 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4484 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4485 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4486 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
4487 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004488
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004489 Example:
4490 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4491 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004492
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004493 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4494 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004496http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4497 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004498
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004499 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4500 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4501 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4502 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004503
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004504 Example:
4505 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004506
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004507 # applied to:
4508 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004509
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004510 # outputs:
4511 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004512
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004513http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4514http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004515
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004516 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4517 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4518 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004519
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004520http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4521 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004522
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004523 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4524 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4525 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4526 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004527
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004528http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004530 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4531 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4532 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4533 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4534 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004536 Arguments:
4537 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4538 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004539
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004540 Example:
4541 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4542 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004544 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4545 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004546
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004547http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004548
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004549 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4550 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4551 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004552
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004553 Arguments:
4554 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4555 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004556
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004557 Example:
4558 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4559 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004561 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4562 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4563 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004564
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004565http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004566
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004567 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4568 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4569 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4570 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4571 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004572
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004573 Example:
4574 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4575 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4576 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4577 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4578 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4579 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4580 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4581 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4582 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004584http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004586 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4587 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4588 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4589 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4590 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004592http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4593 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004595 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4596 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4597 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4598 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4599 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4600 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4601 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4602 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4603 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004604
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004605http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004606
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004607 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4608 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4609 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4610 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4611 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4612 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4613 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004615http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004617 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4618 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4619 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004621http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004622
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004623 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4624 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4625 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4626 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4627 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4628 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4629 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4630 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004632http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004633
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004634 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4635 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4636 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4637 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4638 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4639 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004641 Example :
4642 # prepend the host name before the path
4643 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004644
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004645http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004647 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4648 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4649 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4650 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4651 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004652
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004653http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004655 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4656 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4657 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4658 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4659 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4660 values have higher priority.
4661 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4662 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4663 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4664 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4665 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004666
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004667http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004669 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4670 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4671 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4672 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4673 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4674 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4675 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004677 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004678
4679 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004680 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4681 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004682
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004683http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4684 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4685 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4686 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4687 privacy.
4688
4689 Arguments :
4690 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4691 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004692
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004693 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004694 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4695 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4696
4697 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4698 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4699
4700http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4701
4702 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4703 expression.
4704
4705 Arguments:
4706 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4707 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004708
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004709 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004710 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4711 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4712
4713 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4714 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4715 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4716
4717http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4718
4719 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4720 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4721 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4722 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4723 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4724 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4725 information from the request.
4726
4727 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4728
4729http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4730
4731 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4732 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4733 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4734 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4735 path and the query string.
4736 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4737
4738http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4739
4740 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4741 inline.
4742
4743 Arguments:
4744 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4745 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4746 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4747 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4748 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4749 (request and response)
4750 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4751 processing
4752 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4753 processing
4754 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4755 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4756 and '_'.
4757
4758 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4759 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004760
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004761 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004762 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004763
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004764http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4765 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004766
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004767 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4768 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4769 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4770 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4771 agent name must be used.
4772
4773 Arguments:
4774 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4775
4776 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4777 configuration.
4778
4779http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4780
4781 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4782 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4783 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4784 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4785 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4786 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4787 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4788 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4789 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4790 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4791 action.
4792 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4793 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4794 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4795 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4796 you fully understand how it works.
4797
4798http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4799
4800 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4801 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4802 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4803 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4804 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4805 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4806 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4807 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4808 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4809 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4810 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4811 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4812 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4813
4814http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4815http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4816http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4817
4818 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4819 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4820 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4821 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4822 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4823 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4824 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4825 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4826 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4827 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4828 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4829 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4830
4831 Arguments :
4832 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4833 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4834 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4835 select which table entry to update the counters.
4836
4837 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4838 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4839 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4840 that table until the session ends.
4841
4842 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4843 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4844 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4845 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4846 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4847 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4848 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4849 useful information.
4850
4851 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4852 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4853 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4854 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4855 checks that make use of it.
4856
4857http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4858
4859 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004860
4861 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004862 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004863
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004864http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4865
4866 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4867 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
4868 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
4869 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
4870 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
4871 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4872
4873 Arguments :
4874 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
4875
4876 Example:
4877 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
4878
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004879http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004880
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004881 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4882 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4883 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004884
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004885
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004886http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004887 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4888
4889 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4890 no | yes | yes | yes
4891
4892 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4893 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4894 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4895 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4896 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4897 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4898
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004899 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4900 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004901
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004902 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004903
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004904 Example:
4905 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004906
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004907 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004908
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004909 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4910 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004911
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004912 Example:
4913 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004914
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004915 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004916
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004917 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4918 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004919
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004920 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4921 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004922
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004923http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004925 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4926 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4927 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4928 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4929 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4930 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4931 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4932 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004933
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004934http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004935
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004936 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4937 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4938 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4939 example, or to pass some internal information.
4940 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4941 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4942 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004944http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004945
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004946 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4947 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004948
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004949http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004950
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004951 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004952
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004953http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004954
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004955 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4956 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4957 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4958 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4959 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4960 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4961 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004962
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004963 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4964 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4965 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4966 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4967 keyword.
4968 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4969 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004970
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004971http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004972
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004973 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4974 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4975 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4976 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4977 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4978 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004980http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004981
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004982 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004984http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004985
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004986 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4987 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4988 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4989 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4990 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4991 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004992
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004993http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004994
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004995 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4996 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004997
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004998http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004999
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005000 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5001 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5002 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5003 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5004 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5005 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005006
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005007http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5008 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005009
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005010 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5011 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005012
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005013 Example:
5014 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005015
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005016 # applied to:
5017 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005018
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005019 # outputs:
5020 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005021
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005022 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005023
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005024http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5025 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005026
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005027 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
5028 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005029
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005030 Example:
5031 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005032
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005033 # applied to:
5034 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005036 # outputs:
5037 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005038
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005039http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5040http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005041
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005042 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5043 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5044 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005045
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005046http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5047 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005048
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005049 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5050 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5051 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5052 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005054http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005055
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005056 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5057 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5058 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5059 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5060 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005062 Arguments:
5063 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005065 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5066 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005068http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005069
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005070 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5071 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5072 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005073
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005074http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5075
5076 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5077 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5078 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5079 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5080 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5081
5082http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5083
5084 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5085 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5086 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5087 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5088 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5089 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5090 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5091 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5092 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5093
5094http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5095
5096 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5097 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5098 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5099 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5100 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5101 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5102 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5103
5104http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5105
5106 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5107 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5108 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5109 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5110 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5111 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5112 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5113 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5114
5115http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5116 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5117
5118 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5119 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5120 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5121 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005122
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005123 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005124 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5125 http-response set-status 431
5126 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5127 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005128
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005129http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005130
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005131 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5132 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5133 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5134 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5135 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5136 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5137 based on some information from the request.
5138
5139 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5140
5141http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5142
5143 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5144 inline.
5145
5146 Arguments:
5147 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5148 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5149 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5150 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5151 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5152 (request and response)
5153 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5154 processing
5155 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5156 processing
5157 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5158 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5159 and '_'.
5160
5161 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5162 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005163
5164 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005165 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005167http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005169 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5170 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5171 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5172 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5173 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5174 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5175 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5176 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5177 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5178 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5179 action.
5180 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5181 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5182 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5183 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5184 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005185
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005186http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5187http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5188http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005189
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005190 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5191 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5192 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5193 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5194 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5195 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5196
5197http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5198
5199 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5200 about <var-name>.
5201
5202 Example:
5203 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5204
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005205
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005206http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5207 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5208
5209 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5210 yes | no | yes | yes
5211
5212 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005213 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5214 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5215 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005216
5217 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5218
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005219 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5220 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5221 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5222 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5223 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5224 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5225 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5226 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5227 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5228 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005229
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005230 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5231 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5232 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5233 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5234 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5235 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5236 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5237 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005238
5239 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5240 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5241 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5242 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5243 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5244 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5245 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5246 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005247 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005248 downsides of rare connection failures.
5249
5250 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5251 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5252 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5253 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5254 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5255 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005256 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005257 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5258 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5259 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5260 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5261 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5262
5263 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005264 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5265 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5266 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005267
5268 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005269 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005270
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005271 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5272 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005273
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005274 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005275
5276 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5277 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5278 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5279
5280 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5281
5282
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005283http-send-name-header [<header>]
5284 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005285 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5286 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005287 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005288 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5289
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005290 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5291 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5292 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5293 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5294 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5295 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5296 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5297 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5298 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5299 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5300 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5301 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5302 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5303 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5304 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5305 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005306
5307 See also : "server"
5308
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005309id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005310 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5312 no | yes | yes | yes
5313 Arguments : none
5314
5315 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5316 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5317 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005318
5319
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005320ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5321 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5322 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005323 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005324
5325 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5326 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5327 and running).
5328
5329 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5330 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5331 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005332 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005333 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5334
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005335 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5336 "unless" condition is met.
5337
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005338 Example:
5339 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5340 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5341 ignore-persist if url_static
5342
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005343 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5344
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005345load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5346 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5347 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5348 yes | no | yes | yes
5349
5350 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5351 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5352 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005353 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005354 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5355 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5356 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5357 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5358
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005359 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005360 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005361 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005362
5363 Arguments:
5364 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5365 named "server-state-file".
5366
5367 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5368 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5369 name is used as a file name.
5370
5371 none don't load any stat for this backend
5372
5373 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005374 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5375 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5376 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005377 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005378 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005379
5380 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5381 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5382
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005383 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005384
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005385 global
5386 stats socket /tmp/socket
5387 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005388
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005389 defaults
5390 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005391
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005392 backend bk
5393 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5394 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005395
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005396
5397 Then one can run :
5398
5399 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5400
5401 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5402
5403 1
5404 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5405 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5406 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5407
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005408 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005409
5410 global
5411 stats socket /tmp/socket
5412 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5413
5414 defaults
5415 load-server-state-from-file local
5416
5417 backend bk
5418 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5419 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5420
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005421
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005422 Then one can run :
5423
5424 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5425
5426 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5427
5428 1
5429 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5430 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5431 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5432
5433 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5434 "show servers state"
5435
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005436
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005437log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005438log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5439 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005440no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005441 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5443 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005444
5445 Prefix :
5446 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5447 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5448 prefix does not allow arguments.
5449
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005450 Arguments :
5451 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5452 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5453 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5454 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5455 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5456 parameter.
5457
5458 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5459 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5460
5461 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5462 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5463 standard syslog port).
5464
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005465 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5466 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5467 standard syslog port).
5468
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005469 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5470 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5471 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005472 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005473
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005474 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5475 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5476 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5477 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5478 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5479 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5480 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5481 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5482 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5483 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5484 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5485 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5486 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5487 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5488 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5489 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005490 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5491 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005492
5493 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5494 and "fd@2", see above.
5495
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005496 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5497 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5498 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5499 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5500 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5501 having the logs instantly available.
5502
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005503 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5504 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005505
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005506 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5507 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5508 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5509 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5510 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5511 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5512 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5513 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5514 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5515 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005516 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005517
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005518 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5519 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5520 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5521 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5522 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5523
5524 <sample_size>
5525 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5526 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5527 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5528 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5529 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5530
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005531 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5532 one of the following :
5533
5534 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5535 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5536
5537 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5538 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5539
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005540 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5541 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5542 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5543 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5544 systemd logger consumes.
5545
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005546 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5547 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5548 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5549 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5550
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005551 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5552
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005553 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5554 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5555 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5556
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005557 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5558 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5559 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5560 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005561
5562 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5563 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5564 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005565 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5566 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5567 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5568 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5569 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005570
5571 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5572
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005573 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5574 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5575 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005576
5577 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5578 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5579 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5580 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5581
5582 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5583 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005584
5585 Example :
5586 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005587 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5588 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5589 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005590 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5591 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005592 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005593
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005594
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005595log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005596 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5597 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5598 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005599
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005600 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5601 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5602 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5603 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5604 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005605
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005606 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5607 "option httplog" directives.
5608
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005609log-format-sd <string>
5610 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5611 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5612 yes | yes | yes | no
5613
5614 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5615 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5616 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5617 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5618 which covers the log format string in depth.
5619
5620 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5621 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5622
5623 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5624 log format to "rfc5424".
5625
5626 Example :
5627 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5628
5629
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005630log-tag <string>
5631 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5632 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5633 yes | yes | yes | yes
5634
5635 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5636 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5637 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5638 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5639 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5640 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5641 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5642 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5643 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005644
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005645max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5646 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5647 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5648 yes | no | yes | yes
5649
5650 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5651 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5652 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5653 servers.
5654
5655 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5656 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5657 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5658 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5659 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005660 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005661 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5662 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5663 picking a different server.
5664
5665 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5666 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5667 even if they have to be queued.
5668
5669 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5670 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5671
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005672max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5673 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5674 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5675 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005676
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005677maxconn <conns>
5678 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5680 yes | yes | yes | no
5681 Arguments :
5682 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5683 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5684 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5685 closes.
5686
5687 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5688 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5689 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5690 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005691 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5692 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5693 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5694 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005695
5696 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5697 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5698 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5699
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005700 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5701 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005702
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005703 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5704
5705
5706mode { tcp|http|health }
5707 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5709 yes | yes | yes | yes
5710 Arguments :
5711 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5712 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5713 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5714 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5715
5716 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5717 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5718 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5719 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5720 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5721
5722 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005723 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5724 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5725 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5726 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5727 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5728 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5729 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005730
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005731 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5732 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5733 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005734
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005735 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005736 defaults http_instances
5737 mode http
5738
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005739 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005740
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005741
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005742monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005743 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5745 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005746 Arguments :
5747 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5748 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005749 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005750 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5751 backend and its backup.
5752
5753 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5754 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5755 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5756 servers in a list of backends.
5757
5758 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5759 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5760 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5761 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5762 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5763 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5764 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005765 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5766 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005767
5768 Example:
5769 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005770 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005771 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5772 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5773 monitor-uri /site_alive
5774 monitor fail if site_dead
5775
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005776 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005777
5778
5779monitor-net <source>
5780 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5782 yes | yes | yes | no
5783 Arguments :
5784 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5785 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5786 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5787 followed by a mask.
5788
5789 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5790 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005791 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005792 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5793
5794 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5795 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5796 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5797 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005798 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5799 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5800 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005801
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005802 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5803 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5804 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5805 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5806 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5807 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005808
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005809 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5810 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005811
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005812 Example :
5813 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5814 frontend www
5815 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5816
5817 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5818
5819
5820monitor-uri <uri>
5821 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5823 yes | yes | yes | no
5824 Arguments :
5825 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5826 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5827
5828 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5829 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5830 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5831 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5832 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5833 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5834 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5835 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5836
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005837 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005838 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
5839 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5840 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5841 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5842 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5843 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005844
5845 Example :
5846 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5847 frontend www
5848 mode http
5849 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5850
5851 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5852
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005853
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005854option abortonclose
5855no option abortonclose
5856 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5858 yes | no | yes | yes
5859 Arguments : none
5860
5861 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5862 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5863 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5864 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005865 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005866 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5867 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5868 encountered while delivering the response.
5869
5870 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5871 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5872 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5873 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5874 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5875 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005876 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005877 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005878 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005879 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5880 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5881 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5882
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005883 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5884 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005885 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5886 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5887 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5888 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5889 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5890 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005891 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005892
5893 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5894 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5895
5896 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5897
5898
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005899option accept-invalid-http-request
5900no option accept-invalid-http-request
5901 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5903 yes | yes | yes | no
5904 Arguments : none
5905
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005906 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005907 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005908 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005909 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5910 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5911 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5912 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5913 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005914 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5915 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5916 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5917 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005918 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005919 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005920 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5921 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5922 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005923
5924 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5925 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5926 been confirmed.
5927
5928 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5929 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005930 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5931 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005932 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5933
5934 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5935 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5936
5937 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5938 stats socket.
5939
5940
5941option accept-invalid-http-response
5942no option accept-invalid-http-response
5943 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5945 yes | no | yes | yes
5946 Arguments : none
5947
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005948 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005949 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005950 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005951 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5952 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5953 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5954 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5955 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005956 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5957 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5958 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005959
5960 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5961 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5962 been confirmed.
5963
5964 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5965 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5966 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5967 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5968
5969 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5970 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5971
5972 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5973 stats socket.
5974
5975
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005976option allbackups
5977no option allbackups
5978 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5980 yes | no | yes | yes
5981 Arguments : none
5982
5983 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5984 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5985 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5986 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5987 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5988 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5989 order between the backup servers anymore.
5990
5991 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5992 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5993
5994 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5995 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5996
5997
5998option checkcache
5999no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006000 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6002 yes | no | yes | yes
6003 Arguments : none
6004
6005 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6006 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006007 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006008 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6009 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006010 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006011
6012 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006013 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006014 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006015 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6016 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006017 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006018 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006019 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6020 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006021 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006022 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6023 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006024 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006025 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6026 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6027 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6028 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6029 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6030 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6031 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6032 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6033 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6034
6035 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006036 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6037 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6038 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6039 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006040
6041 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6042 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006043 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006044 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006045
6046 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6047 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6048
6049
6050option clitcpka
6051no option clitcpka
6052 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6054 yes | yes | yes | no
6055 Arguments : none
6056
6057 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6058 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006059 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006060 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6061
6062 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6063 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6064 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6065 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6066
6067 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6068 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6069 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6070 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6071 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6072
6073 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6074
6075 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6076 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6077 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6078
6079 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6080 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6081
6082 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6083
6084
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006085option contstats
6086 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6088 yes | yes | yes | no
6089 Arguments : none
6090
6091 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6092 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6093 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6094 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006095 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6096 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6097 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6098 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6099 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006100
6101
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006102option dontlog-normal
6103no option dontlog-normal
6104 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6106 yes | yes | yes | no
6107 Arguments : none
6108
6109 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6110 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6111 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6112 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6113 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6114 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6115 logged.
6116
6117 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6118 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6119 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6120
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006121 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006122 logging.
6123
6124
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006125option dontlognull
6126no option dontlognull
6127 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6129 yes | yes | yes | no
6130 Arguments : none
6131
6132 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6133 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6134 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6135 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6136 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6137 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006138 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6139 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6140 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006141
6142 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006143 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006144 would not be logged.
6145
6146 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6147 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6148
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006149 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6150 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006151
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006152
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006153option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006154 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6156 yes | yes | yes | yes
6157 Arguments :
6158 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6159 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006160 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006161 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006162
6163 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6164 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6165 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6166 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6167 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6168 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6169 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006170 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6171 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6172 possible that the client has already brought one.
6173
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006174 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006175 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006176 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006177 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006178 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006179 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006180
6181 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6182 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6183 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6184 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6185 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6186 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6187 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6188
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006189 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6190 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6191 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6192 are under the control of the end-user.
6193
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006194 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006195 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6196 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006197 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6198 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6199 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006200
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006201 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006202 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6203 frontend www
6204 mode http
6205 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6206
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006207 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6208 backend www
6209 mode http
6210 option forwardfor header X-Client
6211
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006212 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006213 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006214
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006215
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006216option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6217no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6218 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6220 yes | yes | yes | no
6221 Arguments : none
6222
6223 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6224 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6225 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6226 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6227 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6228 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6229 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6230
6231 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6232 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6233 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6234 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6235 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6236 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6237 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6238 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6239 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6240 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6241
6242 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6243
6244 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6245 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6246
6247 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6248 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6249
6250
6251option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6252no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6253 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6255 yes | no | yes | yes
6256 Arguments : none
6257
6258 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6259 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6260 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6261 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6262 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6263 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6264 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6265
6266 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6267 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6268 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6269 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6270 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6271 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6272 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6273 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6274 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6275 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6276
6277 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6278
6279 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6280 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6281
6282 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6283 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6284
6285
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006286option http-buffer-request
6287no option http-buffer-request
6288 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6290 yes | yes | yes | yes
6291 Arguments : none
6292
6293 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6294 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6295 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6296 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6297 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6298 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006299 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6300 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6301 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6302 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006303
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006304 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006305
6306
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006307option http-ignore-probes
6308no option http-ignore-probes
6309 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6311 yes | yes | yes | no
6312 Arguments : none
6313
6314 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6315 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6316 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6317 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6318 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6319 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6320 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6321 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6322 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006323 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6324 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006325 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6326
6327 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6328 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6329 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6330 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6331 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6332 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6333 are often the only way to detect them.
6334
6335 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6336 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6337
6338 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6339
6340
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006341option http-keep-alive
6342no option http-keep-alive
6343 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6345 yes | yes | yes | yes
6346 Arguments : none
6347
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006348 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6349 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006350 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6351 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006352 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6353 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6354 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006355
6356 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6357 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006358 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6359 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6360 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6361 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6362 situations where this option may be useful :
6363
6364 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006365 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006366
6367 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6368 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6369
6370 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6371 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6372 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6373 request.
6374
6375 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6376 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006377 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6378 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6379 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006380
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006381 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6382 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6383 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6384 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6385 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6386 not set.
6387
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006388 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6389 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6390 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006391
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006392 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006393 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006394 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006395
6396
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006397option http-no-delay
6398no option http-no-delay
6399 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6401 yes | yes | yes | yes
6402 Arguments : none
6403
6404 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6405 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6406 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6407 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6408 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6409 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6410 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6411 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6412 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6413 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6414 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6415 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6416 affected.
6417
6418 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6419 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6420 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6421 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6422 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6423 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6424 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6425 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6426 latency environments.
6427
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006428 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6429
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006430
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006431option http-pretend-keepalive
6432no option http-pretend-keepalive
6433 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006435 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006436 Arguments : none
6437
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006438 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006439 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6440 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6441 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6442 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6443 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6444 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6445 consider the response complete.
6446
6447 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6448 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6449 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6450 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006451 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006452 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6453
6454 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6455 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6456 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6457 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6458 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6459 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6460 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6461
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006462 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6463 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6464 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6465 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6466 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6467 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006468
6469 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6470 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6471
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006472 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006473 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006474
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006475
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006476option http-server-close
6477no option http-server-close
6478 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6480 yes | yes | yes | yes
6481 Arguments : none
6482
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006483 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6484 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6485 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6486 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006487 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6488 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6489 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6490 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6491 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6492 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6493 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6494 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6495 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6496 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6497 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006498
6499 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6500 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6501 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6502 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006503 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6504 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006505
6506 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6507 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006508 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6509 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6510 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006511
6512 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6513 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6514
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006515 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6516 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006517
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006518option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006519no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006520 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6522 yes | yes | yes | no
6523 Arguments : none
6524
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006525 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006526 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6527 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6528 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6529 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6530 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6531 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6532
6533 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6534 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006535 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6536 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6537 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006538
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006539 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6540 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6541 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6542 front of an existing proxy.
6543
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006544 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6545
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006546 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006547
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006548option httpchk
6549option httpchk <uri>
6550option httpchk <method> <uri>
6551option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6552 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6554 yes | no | yes | yes
6555 Arguments :
6556 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6557 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6558 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6559 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6560 ones.
6561
6562 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6563 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6564 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6565
6566 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6567 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6568 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6569 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6570 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6571
6572 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6573 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6574 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6575 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6576 the lack of any response.
6577
6578 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6579
6580 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6581 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6582 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6583
6584 Examples :
6585 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6586 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6587 backend https_relay
6588 mode tcp
6589 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6590 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6591
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006592 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6593 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6594 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006595
6596
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006597option httpclose
6598no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006599 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6601 yes | yes | yes | yes
6602 Arguments : none
6603
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006604 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6605 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6606 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6607 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006608 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006609
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006610 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6611 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006612 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006613 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6614 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006615
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006616 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6617 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6618 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006619
6620 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6621 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006622 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6623 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6624 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006625
6626 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6627 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6628
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006629 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006630
6631
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006632option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006633 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006635 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006636 Arguments :
6637 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6638 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6639 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006640 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006641 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006642
6643 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6644 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6645 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6646 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6647 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6648 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6649 ports.
6650
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006651 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6652 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006653
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006654 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006656 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006657
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006658
6659option http_proxy
6660no option http_proxy
6661 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6663 yes | yes | yes | yes
6664 Arguments : none
6665
6666 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6667 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6668 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6669 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6670 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6671
6672 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6673 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006674 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6675 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006676
6677 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6678 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6679
6680 Example :
6681 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6682 backend direct_forward
6683 option httpclose
6684 option http_proxy
6685
6686 See also : "option httpclose"
6687
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006688
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006689option independent-streams
6690no option independent-streams
6691 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6693 yes | yes | yes | yes
6694 Arguments : none
6695
6696 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6697 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6698 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6699 receive data or not.
6700
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006701 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006702 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6703 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6704 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6705 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6706 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6707 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6708 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6709 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6710 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6711 socket buffers.
6712
6713 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6714 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6715 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6716 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6717 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6718
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006719 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006720
6721
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006722option ldap-check
6723 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6725 yes | no | yes | yes
6726 Arguments : none
6727
6728 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6729 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6730 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6731 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6732
6733 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6734 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6735
6736 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6737 configure it.
6738
6739 Example :
6740 option ldap-check
6741
6742 See also : "option httpchk"
6743
6744
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006745option external-check
6746 Use external processes for server health checks
6747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6748 yes | no | yes | yes
6749
6750 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6751 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6752 command".
6753
6754 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6755
6756 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6757
6758
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006759option log-health-checks
6760no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006761 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6763 yes | no | yes | yes
6764 Arguments : none
6765
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006766 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6767 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6768 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006769
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006770 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6771 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6772 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6773 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6774 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6775
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006776 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006777 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006778
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006779 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6780 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6781 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006782
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006783
6784option log-separate-errors
6785no option log-separate-errors
6786 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6788 yes | yes | yes | no
6789 Arguments : none
6790
6791 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6792 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6793 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6794 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6795 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6796 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6797 provides very important information.
6798
6799 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6800 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6801 error logs.
6802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006803 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006804 logging.
6805
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006806
6807option logasap
6808no option logasap
6809 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6811 yes | yes | yes | no
6812 Arguments : none
6813
6814 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6815 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6816 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6817 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6818 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6819 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6820 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006821 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006822 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6823 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6824
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006825 Examples :
6826 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6827 mode http
6828 option httplog
6829 option logasap
6830 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6831
6832 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6833 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6834 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6835 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6836
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006837 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006838 logging.
6839
6840
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006841option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006842 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6844 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006845 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006846 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6847 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006848 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006849
6850 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6851 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006852 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006853 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6854 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6855 in the MySQL table, like this :
6856
6857 USE mysql;
6858 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6859 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6860
6861 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006862 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006863 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6864 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6865 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6866 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6867 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6868 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6869 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6870
6871 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6872 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006873
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006874 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006875
6876 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6877 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6878 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6879 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006880 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6881 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006882
6883 See also: "option httpchk"
6884
6885
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006886option nolinger
6887no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006888 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006889 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6890 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006891 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006892
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006893 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006894 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6895 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6896 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6897 connections.
6898
6899 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6900 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6901 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6902 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6903 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6904 this too.
6905
6906 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6907 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6908 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6909
6910 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6911 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6912 for servers.
6913
6914 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6915 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6916
6917
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006918option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6919 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6921 yes | yes | yes | yes
6922 Arguments :
6923 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6924 matching <network>
6925 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6926 header name.
6927
6928 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6929 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6930 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6931 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6932 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6933 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6934 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6935 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6936 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6937 possible that the client has already brought one.
6938
6939 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6940 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6941 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6942 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6943 header and requires different one.
6944
6945 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6946 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6947 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6948 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6949 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6950 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6951 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6952
6953 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6954 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6955 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6956 both are defined.
6957
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006958 Examples :
6959 # Original Destination address
6960 frontend www
6961 mode http
6962 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6963
6964 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6965 backend www
6966 mode http
6967 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6968
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006969 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006970
6971
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006972option persist
6973no option persist
6974 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6975 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6976 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006977 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006978
6979 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6980 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6981 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6982 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6983 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6984 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6985 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6986 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6987 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6988 redirected to another valid server.
6989
6990 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6991 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6992
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006993 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006994
6995
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006996option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6997 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6999 yes | no | yes | yes
7000 Arguments :
7001 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7002 PostgreSQL server.
7003
7004 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7005 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7006 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7007 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7008
7009 See also: "option httpchk"
7010
7011
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007012option prefer-last-server
7013no option prefer-last-server
7014 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7015 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7016 yes | no | yes | yes
7017 Arguments : none
7018
7019 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7020 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7021 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7022 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7023 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7024 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7025 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7026 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7027 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007028 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7029 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007030 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7031 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7032 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007033 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7034 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7035 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007036
7037 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7038 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7039
7040 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7041
7042
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007043option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007044option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007045no option redispatch
7046 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7047 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7048 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007049 Arguments :
7050 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7051 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7052 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007053 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007054 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007055 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007056 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7057 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7058 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7059
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007060
7061 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7062 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7063 be able to access the service anymore.
7064
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007065 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7066 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007067
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007068 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007069 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7070 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007071
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007072 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7073 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7074
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007075 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007076
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007077
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007078option redis-check
7079 Use redis health checks for server testing
7080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7081 yes | no | yes | yes
7082 Arguments : none
7083
7084 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7085 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7086 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7087 find the "+PONG" response message.
7088
7089 Example :
7090 option redis-check
7091
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007092 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007093
7094
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007095option smtpchk
7096option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7097 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7099 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007100 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007101 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007102 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007103 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7104
7105 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7106 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7107 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7108
7109 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7110 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7111 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7112 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7113 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7114 dead server.
7115
7116 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7117 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007118 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007119 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7120
7121 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7122 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7123 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7124 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007125 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007126
7127 Example :
7128 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7129
7130 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7131
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007132
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007133option socket-stats
7134no option socket-stats
7135
7136 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7138 yes | yes | yes | no
7139
7140 Arguments : none
7141
7142
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007143option splice-auto
7144no option splice-auto
7145 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7147 yes | yes | yes | yes
7148 Arguments : none
7149
7150 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7151 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007152 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007153 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007154 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007155 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7156 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7157 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7158 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7159
7160 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7161 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7162 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7163 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7164 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7165 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7166 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7167 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7168 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7169 keyword.
7170
7171 Example :
7172 option splice-auto
7173
7174 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7175 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7176
7177 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7178 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7179
7180
7181option splice-request
7182no option splice-request
7183 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7185 yes | yes | yes | yes
7186 Arguments : none
7187
7188 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007189 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007190 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7191 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7192 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7193 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7194
7195 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7196
7197 Example :
7198 option splice-request
7199
7200 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7201 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7202
7203 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7204 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7205
7206
7207option splice-response
7208no option splice-response
7209 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7211 yes | yes | yes | yes
7212 Arguments : none
7213
7214 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007215 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007216 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7217 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7218 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7219 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7220
7221 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7222
7223 Example :
7224 option splice-response
7225
7226 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7227 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7228
7229 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7230 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7231
7232
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007233option spop-check
7234 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7236 no | no | no | yes
7237 Arguments : none
7238
7239 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7240 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7241 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7242 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7243
7244 Example :
7245 option spop-check
7246
7247 See also : "option httpchk"
7248
7249
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007250option srvtcpka
7251no option srvtcpka
7252 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7254 yes | no | yes | yes
7255 Arguments : none
7256
7257 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7258 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007259 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007260 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7261
7262 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7263 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7264 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7265 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7266
7267 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7268 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7269 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7270 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7271 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7272
7273 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7274
7275 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7276 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7277 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7278
7279 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7280 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7281
7282 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7283
7284
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007285option ssl-hello-chk
7286 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7288 yes | no | yes | yes
7289 Arguments : none
7290
7291 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7292 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7293 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7294 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7295 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7296 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7297 hello message.
7298
7299 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7300 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7301 messages, which is appreciable.
7302
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007303 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7304 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7305 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007306
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007307 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7308
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007309
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007310option tcp-check
7311 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7312 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7313 yes | no | yes | yes
7314
7315 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7316 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7317
7318 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7319 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7320 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7321
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007322 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007323 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7324 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7325 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7326 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7327 only.
7328
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007329 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007330 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7331 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7332 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7333 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7334
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007335 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007336 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7337 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007338 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007339 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7340 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7341 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7342 the respective protocols.
7343 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007344 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007345
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007346 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7347 script.
7348
7349 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7350 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7351 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7352 The "comment" is of course optional.
7353
7354
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007355 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007356 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007357 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007358 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007360 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007361 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007362 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007363
7364 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7365 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007366 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007367 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007368 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007369 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007370 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007371 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007372 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7373 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007374 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007375 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7376 tcp-check expect string +OK
7377
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007378 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007379 (send many headers before analyzing)
7380 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007381 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007382 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7383 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7384 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7385 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007386 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007387
7388
7389 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7390
7391
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007392option tcp-smart-accept
7393no option tcp-smart-accept
7394 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7396 yes | yes | yes | no
7397 Arguments : none
7398
7399 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7400 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7401 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7402 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7403 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7404 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7405
7406 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7407 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7408 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7409 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7410
7411 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7412 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7413 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007414 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007415
7416 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7417 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7418 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7419
7420 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7421 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7422 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7423
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007424 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7425
7426
7427option tcp-smart-connect
7428no option tcp-smart-connect
7429 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7431 yes | no | yes | yes
7432 Arguments : none
7433
7434 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7435 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7436 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7437 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7438 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7439
7440 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7441 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7442 complex.
7443
7444 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7445 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7446 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7447
7448 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7449 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7450
7451 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7452
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007453
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007454option tcpka
7455 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7457 yes | yes | yes | yes
7458 Arguments : none
7459
7460 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7461 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007462 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007463 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7464
7465 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7466 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7467 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7468 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7469
7470 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7471 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7472 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7473 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7474 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7475
7476 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7477
7478 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7479 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7480 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7481 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7482 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7483 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7484 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7485 backends.
7486
7487 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7488
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007489
7490option tcplog
7491 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007493 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007494 Arguments : none
7495
7496 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7497 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7498 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7499 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7500 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7501 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7502 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7503 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7504
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007505 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007507 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007508
7509
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007510option transparent
7511no option transparent
7512 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007514 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007515 Arguments : none
7516
7517 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7518 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7519 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7520 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7521 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7522 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7523 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7524 appropriate server.
7525
7526 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7527 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7528
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007529 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007530 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007531
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007532
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007533external-check command <command>
7534 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7536 yes | no | yes | yes
7537
7538 Arguments :
7539 <command> is the external command to run
7540
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007541 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7542
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007543 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007544
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007545 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7546 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7547 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7548 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7549 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7550 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007551
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007552 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7553
7554 Environment variables :
7555 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7556 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7557
7558 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7559
7560 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7561
7562 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7563 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7564 for a UNIX socket).
7565
7566 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7567
7568 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7569
7570 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7571
7572 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7573
7574 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7575
7576 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7577 socket).
7578
7579 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7580 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7581
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007582 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7583
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007584 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7585 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7586 failed.
7587
7588 Example :
7589 external-check command /bin/true
7590
7591 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7592
7593
7594external-check path <path>
7595 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7597 yes | no | yes | yes
7598
7599 Arguments :
7600 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7601
7602 The default path is "".
7603
7604 Example :
7605 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7606
7607 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7608 "external-check command"
7609
7610
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007611persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007612persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007613 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7615 yes | no | yes | yes
7616 Arguments :
7617 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007618 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7619 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007620
7621 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7622 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007623 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007624 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7625 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7626 forwarded to this server.
7627
7628 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7629 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7630 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007631 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007632 a single "listen" section.
7633
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007634 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7635 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7636 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7637
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007638 Example :
7639 listen tse-farm
7640 bind :3389
7641 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7642 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7643 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7644 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7645 persist rdp-cookie
7646 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007647 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007648 balance rdp-cookie
7649 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7650 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7651
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007652 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7653 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007654
7655
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007656rate-limit sessions <rate>
7657 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7659 yes | yes | yes | no
7660 Arguments :
7661 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7662 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7663
7664 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7665 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7666 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7667 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7668 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7669 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7670
7671 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7672 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7673 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7674 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7675
7676 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7677 listen smtp
7678 mode tcp
7679 bind :25
7680 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007681 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007682
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007683 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7684 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7685 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007686
7687 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7688
7689
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007690redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7691redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7692redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007693 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7695 no | yes | yes | yes
7696
7697 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007698 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007699
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007700 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007701 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007702 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7703 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7704 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007705
7706 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7707 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7708 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7709 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7710 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007711 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7712 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7713 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7714 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007715
7716 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7717 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7718 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7719 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7720 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7721 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007722 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007723 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007724 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7725 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7726 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007727
7728 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007729 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7730 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7731 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007732 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007733 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7734 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7735 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7736 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007737
7738 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007739 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007740
7741 - "drop-query"
7742 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7743 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7744 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7745 with a location-type redirect.
7746
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007747 - "append-slash"
7748 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7749 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7750 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7751 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7752
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007753 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7754 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7755 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7756 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7757 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7758 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7759 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7760
7761 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7762 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7763 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7764 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7765 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7766 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7767 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007768
7769 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7770 acl clear dst_port 80
7771 acl secure dst_port 8080
7772 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007773 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007774 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007775 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7776
7777 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007778 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7779 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7780 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007781 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007782
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007783 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7784 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7785 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7786
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007787 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007788 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007789
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007790 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007791 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7792 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7793 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007795 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007796
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007797
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007798retries <value>
7799 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7800 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7801 yes | no | yes | yes
7802 Arguments :
7803 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7804 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7805 default value is 3.
7806
7807 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7808 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7809 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7810
7811 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007812 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7813 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007814
7815 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7816 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7817
7818 See also : "option redispatch"
7819
7820
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007821retry-on [list of keywords]
7822 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7823 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7824 yes | no | yes | yes
7825 Arguments :
7826 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7827 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7828 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7829 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7830
7831 none never retry
7832
7833 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7834 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7835
7836 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7837 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7838 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7839 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7840 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7841 processing the request.
7842
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007843 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7844 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
7845 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
7846 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
7847 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
7848 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
7849 overflow attack for example).
7850
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007851 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
7852 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
7853 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
7854 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
7855 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
7856 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
7857 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
7858 amplify denial of service attacks.
7859
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02007860 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
7861 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
7862 considered to be safe to retry.
7863
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007864 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
7865 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
7866 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
7867 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
7868
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02007869 all-retryable-errors
7870 retry request for any error that are considered
7871 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
7872 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
7873 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
7874
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007875 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
7876 not cumulative.
7877
7878 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
7879 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
7880 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
7881 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
7882
7883 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
7884 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
7885 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
7886 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
7887 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
7888 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
7889 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
7890 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
7891 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
7892 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
7893 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
7894 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
7895
7896 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
7897 should not use this directive.
7898
7899 The default is "conn-failure".
7900
7901 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
7902
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007903server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007904 Declare a server in a backend
7905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7906 no | no | yes | yes
7907 Arguments :
7908 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007909 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007910 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007911
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007912 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7913 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7914 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7915 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007916 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7917 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7918 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7919 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7920 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007921 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7922 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7923 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7924 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7925 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7926 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7927 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007928 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007929 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7930 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7931 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7932 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7933 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7934 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007935 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7936 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007937 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7938 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007939
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007940 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007941 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7942 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7943 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7944 adding this value to the client's port.
7945
7946 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7947 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007948 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007949
7950 Examples :
7951 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7952 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007953 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007954 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7955 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7956 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007957
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007958 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7959 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7960 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7961 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7962 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7963
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007964 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7965 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007966
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007967server-state-file-name [<file>]
7968 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7969 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7970 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7971 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7972 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7973 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7974
7975 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7976 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7977
7978 global
7979 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7980
7981 backend bk
7982 load-server-state-from-file
7983
7984 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7985 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007986
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007987server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7988 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7989 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7991 no | no | yes | yes
7992
7993 Arguments:
7994 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7995
7996 <num | range>
7997 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7998 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7999 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8000 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8001
8002 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8003
8004 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8005
8006 <params*>
8007 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8008 keyword.
8009
8010 Examples:
8011 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8012 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8013 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8014
8015 # or
8016 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8017
8018 # would be equivalent to:
8019 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8020 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8021 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8022
8023
8024
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008025source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008026source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008027source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008028 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8030 yes | no | yes | yes
8031 Arguments :
8032 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8033 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008034
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008035 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008036 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8037 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8038 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8039 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8040 supported prefixes are :
8041 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8042 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8043 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008044 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008045 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8046 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008047
8048 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8049 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008050 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8051 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8052 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008053
8054 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8055 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8056 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8057 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8058 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8059 <addr>.
8060
8061 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8062 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8063 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8064 port.
8065
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008066 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8067 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8068 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8069 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008070 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008071 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8072 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8073 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8074 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8075 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8076 HTTP header.
8077
8078 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8079 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008080 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008081 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8082 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8083 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8084 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8085 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8086 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8087 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8088
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008089 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8090 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8091 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8092 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8093 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8094 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8095
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008096 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8097 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8098 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8099 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8100
8101 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8102 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8103 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8104 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8105 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8106 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8107
8108 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8109 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8110 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8111 there are two methods :
8112
8113 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8114 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8115 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8116 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8117 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8118 of the client ranges may be used.
8119
8120 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8121 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8122 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8123 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8124 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8125 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8126 same session.
8127
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008128 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8129 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8130 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008131 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008132
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008133 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8134
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008135 Examples :
8136 backend private
8137 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8138 source 192.168.1.200
8139
8140 backend transparent_ssl1
8141 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8142 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8143
8144 backend transparent_ssl2
8145 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8146 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8147 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8148
8149 backend transparent_ssl3
8150 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8151 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8152 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8153
8154 backend transparent_smtp
8155 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8156 # with Tproxy version 4.
8157 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8158
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008159 backend transparent_http
8160 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8161 # proxy.
8162 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008164 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008165 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8166
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008167
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008168stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8169 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008171 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008172
8173 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8174 matched.
8175
8176 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8177 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8178
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008179 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8180 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008181 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008182
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008183 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8184 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8185 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8186 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008187
8188 Example :
8189 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8190 backend stats_localhost
8191 stats enable
8192 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8193
8194 Example :
8195 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8196 backend stats_auth
8197 stats enable
8198 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8199 stats admin if TRUE
8200
8201 Example :
8202 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8203 userlist stats-auth
8204 group admin users admin
8205 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8206 group readonly users haproxy
8207 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8208
8209 backend stats_auth
8210 stats enable
8211 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8212 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8213 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8214 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8215
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008216 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8217 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8218 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008219
8220
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008221stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8222 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008224 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008225 Arguments :
8226 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8227
8228 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8229
8230 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8231 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8232 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8233 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8234 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8235 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8236
8237 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8238 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8239 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008240 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008241
8242 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8243 report using "stats scope".
8244
8245 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8246 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8247 unobvious parameters.
8248
8249 Example :
8250 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8251 backend public_www
8252 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8253 stats enable
8254 stats hide-version
8255 stats scope .
8256 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008257 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008258 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8259 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8260
8261 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8262 backend private_monitoring
8263 stats enable
8264 stats uri /admin?stats
8265 stats refresh 5s
8266
8267 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8268
8269
8270stats enable
8271 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008273 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008274 Arguments : none
8275
8276 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8277 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8278 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8279 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8280 - stats auth : no authentication
8281 - stats scope : no restriction
8282
8283 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8284 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8285 unobvious parameters.
8286
8287 Example :
8288 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8289 backend public_www
8290 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8291 stats enable
8292 stats hide-version
8293 stats scope .
8294 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008295 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008296 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8297 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8298
8299 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8300 backend private_monitoring
8301 stats enable
8302 stats uri /admin?stats
8303 stats refresh 5s
8304
8305 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8306
8307
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008308stats hide-version
8309 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008311 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008312 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008313
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008314 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8315 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8316 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8317 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8318 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8319 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008320
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008321 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8322 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8323 unobvious parameters.
8324
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008325 Example :
8326 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8327 backend public_www
8328 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008329 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008330 stats hide-version
8331 stats scope .
8332 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008333 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008334 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8335 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008336
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008337 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8338 backend private_monitoring
8339 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008340 stats uri /admin?stats
8341 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008342
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008343 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008344
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008345
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008346stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8347 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8348 Access control for statistics
8349
8350 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8351 no | no | yes | yes
8352
8353 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8354 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8355 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8356 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8357 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8358 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8359
8360 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8361 instance.
8362
8363 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8364 about ACL usage.
8365
8366
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008367stats realm <realm>
8368 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008370 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008371 Arguments :
8372 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8373 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8374 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8375
8376 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8377 using a backslash ('\').
8378
8379 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8380 only related to authentication.
8381
8382 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8383 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8384 unobvious parameters.
8385
8386 Example :
8387 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8388 backend public_www
8389 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8390 stats enable
8391 stats hide-version
8392 stats scope .
8393 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008394 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008395 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8396 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8397
8398 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8399 backend private_monitoring
8400 stats enable
8401 stats uri /admin?stats
8402 stats refresh 5s
8403
8404 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8405
8406
8407stats refresh <delay>
8408 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008410 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008411 Arguments :
8412 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8413 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8414 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8415 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8416 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8417 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8418
8419 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8420 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8421 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8422 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8423
8424 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8425 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8426 unobvious parameters.
8427
8428 Example :
8429 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8430 backend public_www
8431 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8432 stats enable
8433 stats hide-version
8434 stats scope .
8435 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008436 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008437 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8438 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8439
8440 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8441 backend private_monitoring
8442 stats enable
8443 stats uri /admin?stats
8444 stats refresh 5s
8445
8446 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8447
8448
8449stats scope { <name> | "." }
8450 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008452 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008453 Arguments :
8454 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8455 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8456 section in which the statement appears.
8457
8458 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8459 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8460 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8461 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8462 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8463 exists.
8464
8465 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8466 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8467 unobvious parameters.
8468
8469 Example :
8470 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8471 backend public_www
8472 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8473 stats enable
8474 stats hide-version
8475 stats scope .
8476 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008477 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008478 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8479 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8480
8481 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8482 backend private_monitoring
8483 stats enable
8484 stats uri /admin?stats
8485 stats refresh 5s
8486
8487 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8488
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008489
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008490stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008491 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008493 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008494
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008495 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008496 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8497
8498 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8499 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8500
8501 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8502 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008503 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008504
8505 Example :
8506 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8507 backend private_monitoring
8508 stats enable
8509 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8510 stats uri /admin?stats
8511 stats refresh 5s
8512
8513 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8514 global section.
8515
8516
8517stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008518 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8520 yes | yes | yes | yes
8521 Arguments : none
8522
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008523 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008524 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8525 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8526 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8527 - IP (socket, server)
8528 - cookie (backend, server)
8529
8530 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8531 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008532 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008533
8534 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8535
8536
8537stats show-node [ <name> ]
8538 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008540 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008541 Arguments:
8542 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8543 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8544
8545 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8546 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008547 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008548
8549 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8550 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8551 unobvious parameters.
8552
8553 Example:
8554 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8555 backend private_monitoring
8556 stats enable
8557 stats show-node Europe-1
8558 stats uri /admin?stats
8559 stats refresh 5s
8560
8561 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8562 section.
8563
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008564
8565stats uri <prefix>
8566 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008568 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008569 Arguments :
8570 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8571 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8572 query string.
8573
8574 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8575 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8576 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8577 possible to reach it in the application.
8578
8579 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008580 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008581 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8582 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8583 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8584 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8585
8586 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8587 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8588 an address or a port to statistics only.
8589
8590 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8591 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8592 unobvious parameters.
8593
8594 Example :
8595 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8596 backend public_www
8597 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8598 stats enable
8599 stats hide-version
8600 stats scope .
8601 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008602 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008603 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8604 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8605
8606 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8607 backend private_monitoring
8608 stats enable
8609 stats uri /admin?stats
8610 stats refresh 5s
8611
8612 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8613
8614
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008615stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8616 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008618 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008619
8620 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008621 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008622 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008623 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008624 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8625
8626 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8627 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8628 the "stick-table" statement.
8629
8630 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8631 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8632 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8633 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8634 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8635
8636 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8637 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8638 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8639 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8640 transformation rules.
8641
8642 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8643 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8644 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8645 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8646 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8647 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8648 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8649
8650 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8651 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8652 ACL based conditions.
8653
8654 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8655 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8656 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8657 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8658
8659 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8660 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8661 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8662 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8663
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008664 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8665 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008666 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008667
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008668 Example :
8669 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8670 # last 30 minutes
8671 backend pop
8672 mode tcp
8673 balance roundrobin
8674 stick store-request src
8675 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8676 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8677 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8678
8679 backend smtp
8680 mode tcp
8681 balance roundrobin
8682 stick match src table pop
8683 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8684 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8685
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008686 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008687 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008688
8689
8690stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8691 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8693 no | no | yes | yes
8694
8695 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8696 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8697 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8698 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8699
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008700 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8701 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008702 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008703
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008704 Examples :
8705 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008706 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008707
8708 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8709 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8710 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8711
8712
8713 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8714 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8715 backend http
8716 mode http
8717 balance roundrobin
8718 stick on src table https
8719 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8720 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8721 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8722
8723 backend https
8724 mode tcp
8725 balance roundrobin
8726 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8727 stick on src
8728 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8729 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8730
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008731 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008732
8733
8734stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8735 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8737 no | no | yes | yes
8738
8739 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008740 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008741 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008742 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008743 server is selected.
8744
8745 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8746 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8747 the "stick-table" statement.
8748
8749 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8750 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8751 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8752 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8753 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8754 address.
8755
8756 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8757 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8758 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8759 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8760 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8761 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8762 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8763 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8764 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8765 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8766
8767 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8768 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8769 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8770 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8771 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8772 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8773 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8774
8775 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8776 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8777 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8778 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8779
8780 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8781 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8782 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8783 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8784 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8785 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008786 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8787 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8788 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8789 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8790 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8791 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008792
8793 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8794 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8795 the request.
8796
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008797 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8798 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008799 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008800
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008801 Example :
8802 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8803 # last 30 minutes
8804 backend pop
8805 mode tcp
8806 balance roundrobin
8807 stick store-request src
8808 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8809 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8810 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8811
8812 backend smtp
8813 mode tcp
8814 balance roundrobin
8815 stick match src table pop
8816 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8817 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8818
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008819 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008820 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008821
8822
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008823stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008824 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8825 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008826 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008828 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008829
8830 Arguments :
8831 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8832 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8833 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8834 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8835
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008836 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8837 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8838 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8839 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8840
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008841 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8842 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8843 instance.
8844
8845 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8846 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8847 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8848 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8849 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8850 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008851 to 32 characters.
8852
8853 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8854 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8855 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008856 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008857 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8858 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008859
8860 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008861 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8862 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008863 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8864 increase.
8865
8866 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008867 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8868 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8869 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008870
8871 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8872 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8873 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8874 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008875 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008876 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8877 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8878 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8879 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8880 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8881 parameter (see below).
8882
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008883 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8884 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8885 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8886 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8887 soft restart.
8888
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008889 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8890 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008891
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008892 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8893 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8894 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8895 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008896 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008897 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008898 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8899 if not expiration delay is specified.
8900
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008901 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8902 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8903 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8904 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008905 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8906 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8907 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8908 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8909 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8910 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8911 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8912 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8913 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8914 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8915 types and their arguments.
8916
8917 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8918 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8919 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8920 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8921
8922 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8923 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8924 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008925 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008926
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008927 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8928 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8929 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008930 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008931 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008932 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008933
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008934 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8935 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8936 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8937 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8938
8939 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8940 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8941 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8942 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8943 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8944 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8945
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008946 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8947 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8948 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8949 they were received.
8950
8951 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8952 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8953 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8954 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8955 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8956
8957 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8958 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8959 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8960 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8961 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8962
8963 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8964 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8965 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8966
8967 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8968 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8969 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8970 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8971 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8972
8973 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8974 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8975 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8976 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8977 the client side.
8978
8979 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8980 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8981 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8982 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8983 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8984 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8985 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8986
8987 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8988 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8989 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8990 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8991 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8992 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008993 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008994
8995 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8996 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8997 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8998 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8999 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9000 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9001
9002 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009003 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009004 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9005 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9006
9007 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9008 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9009 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9010 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9011 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9012 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9013 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9014 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9015 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9016 recommended for better fairness.
9017
9018 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009019 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009020 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9021 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9022
9023 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9024 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9025 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9026 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9027 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9028 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9029 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9030 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9031 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9032 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009033
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009034 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9035 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009036 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9037 reference it.
9038
9039 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9040 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009041 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9042 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9043 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009044
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009045 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9046 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9047 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9048 something that can be ignored.
9049
9050 Example:
9051 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9052 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9053 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9054 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9055
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009056 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009057 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009058
9059
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009060stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009061 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9063 no | no | yes | yes
9064
9065 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009066 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009067 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009068 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009069 server is selected.
9070
9071 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9072 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9073 the "stick-table" statement.
9074
9075 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9076 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9077 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9078 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9079
9080 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9081 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9082 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9083 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9084 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9085 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009086 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009087 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9088 rules.
9089
9090 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9091 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9092 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9093 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9094 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9095 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9096 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9097
9098 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9099 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9100 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9101 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9102
9103 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9104 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9105 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9106 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9107 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9108 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009109 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9110 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9111 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9112 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9113 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9114 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9115 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9116 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9117 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009118
9119 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9120
9121 Example :
9122 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9123 backend https
9124 mode tcp
9125 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009126 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009127 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009128
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009129 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9130 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9131
9132 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9133 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9134 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9135
9136 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9137 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009138
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009139 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9140 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9141 # at offset 44.
9142
9143 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9144 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9145
9146 # Learn on response if server hello.
9147 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009148
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009149 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9150 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9151
9152 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9153 extraction.
9154
9155
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009156tcp-check connect [params*]
9157 Opens a new connection
9158 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9159 no | no | yes | yes
9160
9161 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9162 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9163 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9164
9165 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9166 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9167 of the sequence.
9168
9169 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9170 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9171 do.
9172
9173 Parameters :
9174 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9175 use the TCP connection.
9176
9177 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9178 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9179 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9180
9181 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9182
9183 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9184
9185 Examples:
9186 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9187 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9188 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9189 option tcp-check
9190 tcp-check connect
9191 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9192 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9193 tcp-check send \r\n
9194 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9195 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9196 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9197 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9198 tcp-check send \r\n
9199 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9200 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9201
9202 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9203 option tcp-check
9204 tcp-check connect port 110
9205 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9206 tcp-check connect port 143
9207 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9208 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9209
9210 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9211
9212
9213tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009214 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009215 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9216 no | no | yes | yes
9217
9218 Arguments :
9219 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9220 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9221 binary.
9222 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9223 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9224 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9225
9226 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9227 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9228 with the usual backslash ('\').
9229 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009230 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009231 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9232 used upper or lower case.
9233
9234
9235 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9236
9237 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9238 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9239 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9240 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9241 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9242 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9243 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9244 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9245
9246 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9247 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9248 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9249 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9250 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9251 expression.
9252
9253 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9254 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9255 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9256 this exact hexadecimal string.
9257 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9258
9259 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9260 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9261 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9262 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9263 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9264 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9265 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9266 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9267 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9268 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9269 the null character.
9270
9271 Examples :
9272 # perform a POP check
9273 option tcp-check
9274 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9275
9276 # perform an IMAP check
9277 option tcp-check
9278 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9279
9280 # look for the redis master server
9281 option tcp-check
9282 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009283 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009284 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9285 tcp-check expect string role:master
9286 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9287 tcp-check expect string +OK
9288
9289
9290 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9291 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9292
9293
9294tcp-check send <data>
9295 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9296 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9297 no | no | yes | yes
9298
9299 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9300 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9301
9302 Examples :
9303 # look for the redis master server
9304 option tcp-check
9305 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9306 tcp-check expect string role:master
9307
9308 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9309 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9310
9311
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009312tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9313 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009314 tcp health check
9315 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9316 no | no | yes | yes
9317
9318 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9319 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009320 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009321 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9322 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9323 hexadecimal string.
9324 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9325
9326 Examples :
9327 # redis check in binary
9328 option tcp-check
9329 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9330 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9331
9332
9333 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9334 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9335
9336
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009337tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9338 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9340 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009341 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009342 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9343 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009344
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009345 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009346
9347 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9348 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009349 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9350 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9351 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9352 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9353 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9354 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009355
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009356 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9357 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9358 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9359 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009360
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009361 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009362 - accept :
9363 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9364 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9365 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009366
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009367 - reject :
9368 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9369 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9370 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9371 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9372 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9373 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9374 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9375 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9376 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9377 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9378 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009379 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009380
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009381 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9382 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9383 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9384 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9385 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9386 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9387 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9388 hosts.
9389
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009390 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9391 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9392 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9393 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9394 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9395 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9396 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9397 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9398
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009399 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9400 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9401 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9402 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9403 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9404 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9405 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9406 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9407 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009408 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9409 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009410
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009411 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009412 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009413 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9414 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9415 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009416 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009417 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9418 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9419 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9420 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9421 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9422 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9423 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9424 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009425
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009426 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009427 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009428 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009429 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009430 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9431 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9432 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009433
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009434 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9435 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9436 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9437 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009438
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009439 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9440 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9441 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9442 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9443 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009444 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9445 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9446 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9447 layer7 information is extracted.
9448
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009449 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9450 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9451 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9452 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9453 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009454
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009455 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9456 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9457 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9458 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9459
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009460 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9461 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9462 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9463 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9464
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009465 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
9466 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9467 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9468 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9469 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009470
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009471 - set-src <expr> :
9472 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9473 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9474 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009475 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009476
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009477 Arguments:
9478 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9479 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009480
9481 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009482 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9483
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009484 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9485 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009486
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009487 - set-src-port <expr> :
9488 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9489 expression.
9490
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009491 Arguments:
9492 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9493 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009494
9495 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009496 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9497
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009498 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9499 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9500 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009501
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009502 - set-dst <expr> :
9503 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9504 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9505 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9506 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9507 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9508
9509 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9510 followed by some converters.
9511
9512 Example:
9513
9514 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9515 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9516
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009517 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9518 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9519
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009520 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9521 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9522 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9523 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9524
9525
9526 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9527 followed by some converters.
9528
9529 Example:
9530
9531 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9532
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009533 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9534 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9535 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9536
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009537 - "silent-drop" :
9538 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009539 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009540 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9541 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9542 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9543 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9544 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009545 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9546 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009547 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9548 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009549 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009550 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9551 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9552 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9553 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9554
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009555 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9556 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9557 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009558
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009559 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9560 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9561 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009562
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009563 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009564 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009565 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009566
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009567 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9568 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9569 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009570
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009571 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009572 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9573 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009574
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009575 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9576
9577 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9578
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009579 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9580
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009581 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009582
9583
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009584tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9585 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009587 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009588 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009589 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9590 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009591
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009592 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009593
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009594 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009595 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9596 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9597 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9598 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009599
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009600 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9601 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9602 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9603 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009604 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9605 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9606 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9607 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9608 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9609 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009610 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009611 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009612
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009613 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9614 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9615 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9616 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009617
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009618 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009619 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009620 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009621 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9622 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009623 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009624 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009625 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009626 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009627 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009628 - set-dst <expr>
9629 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009630 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009631 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009632 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009633 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009634 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009635
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009636 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9637 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009638 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9639 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009640
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009641 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9642 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9643 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9644 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9645 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9646 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009647
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009648 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009649 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9650 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009651
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009652 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009653 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9654 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9655 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9656 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009657 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9658 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9659 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009660
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009661 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009662 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9663 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9664 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009665
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009666 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9667 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9668
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009669 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009670 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9671 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009672
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009673 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9674 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009675 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009676 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9677 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009678 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009679 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009680 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009681 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9682 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009683 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009684 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9685 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009686
9687 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9688 followed by some converters.
9689
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009690 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9691 <var-name>.
9692
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009693 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9694 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9695 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9696 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9697 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9698
9699 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9700 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9701 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9702 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9703 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9704 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9705 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9706 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9707 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9708 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9709 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9710
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009711 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9712 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9713 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9714 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9715 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9716
9717 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9718
9719 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9720
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009721 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
9722 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
9723 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
9724 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
9725 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
9726 evaluated.
9727
9728 Example:
9729 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
9730
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009731 Example:
9732
9733 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009734 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009735
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009736 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009737 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9738 # and reject everything else.
9739 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9740 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009741 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009742 tcp-request content reject
9743
9744 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009745 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9746 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9747 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009748 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009749
9750 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9751 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9752 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009753 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009754 tcp-request content reject
9755
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009756 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009757 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009758 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009759 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009760 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9761 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009762
9763 Example:
9764 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9765 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009766 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009767
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009768 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009769 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009770
9771 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009772 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009773 # protecting all our sites
9774 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009775 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9776 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009777 ...
9778 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9779
9780 backend http_dynamic
9781 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009782 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009783 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009784 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009785 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009786 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009787 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009789 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009790
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009791 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9792 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009793
9794
9795tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9796 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009798 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009799 Arguments :
9800 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9801 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9802 as explained at the top of this document.
9803
9804 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9805 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9806 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9807 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9808 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9809
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009810 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9811 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9812 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9813 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9814
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009815 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9816 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009817 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009818 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009819 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9820 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9821 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9822 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009823
9824 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9825 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9826 it pass through unaffected.
9827
9828 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9829 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9830 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009831 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009832 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9833 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009834 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9835 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9836 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009837
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009838 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009839 "timeout client".
9840
9841
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009842tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9843 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9845 no | no | yes | yes
9846 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009847 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9848 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009849
9850 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9851
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009852 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009853 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9854 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009855 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9856 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009857
9858 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9859
9860 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9861 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9862 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9863 inserted.
9864
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009865 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009866 - accept :
9867 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9868 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9869 the rules evaluation.
9870
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009871 - close :
9872 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9873 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9874 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9875 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9876 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9877 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009878 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009879 protocols.
9880
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009881 - reject :
9882 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9883 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009884 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009885
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009886 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9887 Sets a variable.
9888
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009889 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9890 Unsets a variable.
9891
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009892 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9893 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9894 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9895 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9896
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009897 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9898 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9899 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9900 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9901
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009902 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
9903 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9904 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9905 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9906 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009907
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009908 - "silent-drop" :
9909 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009910 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009911 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9912 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9913 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9914 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9915 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009916 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9917 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009918 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9919 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009920 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009921 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9922 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9923 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9924 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9925
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009926 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9927 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9928
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009929 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9930 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9931 for changing the default action to a reject.
9932
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009933 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9934 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9935 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9936 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009937 period.
9938
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009939 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9940 declared inline.
9941
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009942 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9943 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009944 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009945 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9946 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009947 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009948 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009949 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009950 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9951 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009952 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009953 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9954 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009955
9956 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9957 followed by some converters.
9958
9959 Example:
9960
9961 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9962
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009963 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9964 <var-name>.
9965
9966 Example:
9967
9968 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9969
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009970 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9971 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9972 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9973 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9974 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9975
9976 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9977
9978 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9979
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009980 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9981
9982 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9983
9984
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009985tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9986 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9988 no | yes | yes | no
9989 Arguments :
9990 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9991 below.
9992
9993 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9994
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009995 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009996 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9997 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9998 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9999 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10000 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10001 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10002 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010003 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010004 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10005 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10006 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10007 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10008 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10009 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10010 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10011 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10012 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10013 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10014 instead.
10015
10016 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10017 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10018 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10019 rules which may be inserted.
10020
10021 Several types of actions are supported :
10022 - accept : the request is accepted
10023 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10024 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10025 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010026 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010027 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010028 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010029 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010030 - silent-drop
10031
10032 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10033 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10034 sections for a complete description.
10035
10036 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10037 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10038 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10039
10040 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10041 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10042 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10043 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10044 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10045
10046 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10047 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10048
10049 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10050 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10051 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10052
10053 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10054 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10055 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10056
10057 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10058 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10059 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10060
10061 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10062 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10063 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10064
10065 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10066
10067 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10068
10069
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010070tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10071 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10073 no | no | yes | yes
10074 Arguments :
10075 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10076 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10077 as explained at the top of this document.
10078
10079 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10080
10081
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010082timeout check <timeout>
10083 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10084 established.
10085
10086 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10087 yes | no | yes | yes
10088 Arguments:
10089 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10090 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10091 as explained at the top of this document.
10092
10093 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10094 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010095 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010096 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010097 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10098 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10099 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010100
10101 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10102 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10103
10104 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10105 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010106 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010107
10108 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10109 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10110 forget about it.
10111
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010112 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10113 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010114
10115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010116timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010117 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10119 yes | yes | yes | no
10120 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010121 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010122 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10123 as explained at the top of this document.
10124
10125 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10126 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10127 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010128 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10129 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10130 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10131 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010132 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10133 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10134 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010135 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010136 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010137 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10138 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010139 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10140 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010141
10142 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10143 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10144 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10145 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010146 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010147 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10148
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010149 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010150
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010151 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010152
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010153
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010154timeout client-fin <timeout>
10155 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10157 yes | yes | yes | no
10158 Arguments :
10159 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10160 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10161 as explained at the top of this document.
10162
10163 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10164 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10165 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10166 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10167 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10168 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10169 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010170 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10171 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10172 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010173
10174 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10175 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10176 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10177
10178 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10179
10180
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010181timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010182 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10184 yes | no | yes | yes
10185 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010186 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010187 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10188 as explained at the top of this document.
10189
10190 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010191 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010192 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010193 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010194 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10195 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010196
10197 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10198 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10199 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10200 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010201 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010202 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10203
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010204 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010205
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010206
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010207timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10208 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10210 yes | yes | yes | yes
10211 Arguments :
10212 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10213 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10214 as explained at the top of this document.
10215
10216 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10217 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10218 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10219 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10220 once the request has started to present itself.
10221
10222 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10223 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10224 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10225 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10226 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10227
10228 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10229 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10230 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10231 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10232
10233 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10234 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010235 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010236 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10237 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010238 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010239
10240 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10241 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10242 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10243 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10244
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010245 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10246 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010247 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10248
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010249 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10250
10251
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010252timeout http-request <timeout>
10253 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010255 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010256 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010257 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010258 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10259 as explained at the top of this document.
10260
10261 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10262 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10263 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10264 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10265 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10266 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10267 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010268 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10269 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10270 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10271 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010272 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010273 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10274 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010275
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010276 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10277 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10278 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10279 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10280 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010281 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010282
10283 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10284 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010285 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010286 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10287 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10288
10289 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010290 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10291 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10292 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010293
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010294 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010295 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010296
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010297
10298timeout queue <timeout>
10299 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10301 yes | no | yes | yes
10302 Arguments :
10303 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10304 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10305 as explained at the top of this document.
10306
10307 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10308 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10309 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10310 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10311 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10312
10313 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10314 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10315 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10316 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10317
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010318 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010319
10320
10321timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010322 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10324 yes | no | yes | yes
10325 Arguments :
10326 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10327 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10328 as explained at the top of this document.
10329
10330 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10331 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10332 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10333 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10334 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10335 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10336 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10337
10338 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10339 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10340 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10341 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10342 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010343 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010344 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010345 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10346 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010347 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10348 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010349
10350 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10351 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10352 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10353 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010354 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010355 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10356
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010357 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010358
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010359
10360timeout server-fin <timeout>
10361 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10363 yes | no | yes | yes
10364 Arguments :
10365 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10366 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10367 as explained at the top of this document.
10368
10369 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10370 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10371 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10372 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10373 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10374 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10375 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10376 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10377 situations, it should not be needed.
10378
10379 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10380 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10381 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10382
10383 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10384
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010385
10386timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010387 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10389 yes | yes | yes | yes
10390 Arguments :
10391 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10392 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10393 as explained at the top of this document.
10394
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010395 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10396 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10397 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010398
10399 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10400 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10401 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10402 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010403 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010404
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010405 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010406
10407
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010408timeout tunnel <timeout>
10409 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10411 yes | no | yes | yes
10412 Arguments :
10413 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10414 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10415 as explained at the top of this document.
10416
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010417 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010418 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10419 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10420 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010421 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10422 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010423 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10424 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10425 specified.
10426
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010427 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10428 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10429 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10430 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10431 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10432 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10433 state.
10434
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010435 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10436 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10437 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10438 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010439 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010440
10441 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10442 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10443 forget about it.
10444
10445 Example :
10446 defaults http
10447 option http-server-close
10448 timeout connect 5s
10449 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010450 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010451 timeout server 30s
10452 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10453
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010454 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010455
10456
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010457transparent (deprecated)
10458 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010460 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010461 Arguments : none
10462
10463 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10464 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10465 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10466 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10467 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10468 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10469 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10470 appropriate server.
10471
10472 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10473
10474 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10475 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10476
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010477 See also: "option transparent"
10478
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010479unique-id-format <string>
10480 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10482 yes | yes | yes | no
10483 Arguments :
10484 <string> is a log-format string.
10485
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010486 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10487 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10488 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10489 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010490
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010491 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10492 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10493 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10494 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10495 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10496 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10497 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10498 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010499
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010500 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10501 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010502
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010503 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010504
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010505 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010506
10507 will generate:
10508
10509 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10510
10511 See also: "unique-id-header"
10512
10513unique-id-header <name>
10514 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10516 yes | yes | yes | no
10517 Arguments :
10518 <name> is the name of the header.
10519
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010520 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10521 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010522
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010523 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010524
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010525 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010526 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10527
10528 will generate:
10529
10530 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10531
10532 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010533
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010534use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010535 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10537 no | yes | yes | no
10538 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010539 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10540 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010541
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010542 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10543 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010544
10545 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10546 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10547 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010548 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010549 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010550 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10551 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010552
10553 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10554 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10555 assign the backend.
10556
10557 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10558 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10559 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10560 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10561 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10562 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10563
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010564 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010565 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010566 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10567 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10568 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10569
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010570 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10571 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10572 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10573 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10574 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10575 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10576 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10577 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10578 cannot be forced from the request.
10579
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010580 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010581 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10582 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10583
10584 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10585 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010586
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020010587use-fcgi-app <name>
10588 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
10589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10590 no | no | yes | yes
10591 Arguments :
10592 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
10593
10594 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010595
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010596use-server <server> if <condition>
10597use-server <server> unless <condition>
10598 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10600 no | no | yes | yes
10601 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010602 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010603
10604 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10605
10606 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10607 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10608 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10609
10610 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10611 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10612 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10613 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10614 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10615 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10616 matches will assign the server.
10617
10618 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10619 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10620 with the next rules until one matches.
10621
10622 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10623 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10624 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10625 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10626
10627 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10628 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10629 stripped.
10630
10631 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10632 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10633 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10634 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10635
10636 Example :
10637 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10638 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10639 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10640 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10641 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10642 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010643 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010644 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10645 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10646
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010647 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010648
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010649
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100106505. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010651--------------------------
10652
10653The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10654depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10655settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10656written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10657described in this section.
10658
10659
106605.1. Bind options
10661-----------------
10662
10663The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10664as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10665no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10666parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10667while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10668provided immediately after the setting name.
10669
10670The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10671
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010672accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10673 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10674 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10675 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10676 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10677 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10678 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10679 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10680 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10681 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010682 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10683 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10684 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010685
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010686accept-proxy
10687 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010688 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10689 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010690 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10691 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10692 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10693 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010694 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010695 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10696 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010697 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10698 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010699
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010700allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010701 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010702 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010703 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010704 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10705 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010706
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010707alpn <protocols>
10708 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10709 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10710 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010711 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010712 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010713 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10714 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10715 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10716 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10717 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10718 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10719 preference, like below :
10720
10721 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010722
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010723backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010724 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010725 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10726
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010727curves <curves>
10728 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10729 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10730 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10731 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10732 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10733 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10734
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010735ecdhe <named curve>
10736 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010737 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10738 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010739
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010740ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010741 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10742 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10743 client's certificate.
10744
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010745ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10746 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10747 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10748 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10749 error is ignored.
10750
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010751ca-sign-file <cafile>
10752 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10753 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10754 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10755 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10756 'generate-certificates' for details.
10757
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010758ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010759 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10760 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10761 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10762 'generate-certificates' for details.
10763
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010764ciphers <ciphers>
10765 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10766 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010767 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010768 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010769 information and recommendations see e.g.
10770 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10771 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10772 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10773
10774ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10775 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10776 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10777 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10778 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010779 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10780 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010781
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010782crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010783 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10784 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10785 to verify client's certificate.
10786
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010787crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010788 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10789 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10790 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10791 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10792 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10793 file.
10794
10795 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10796 are loaded.
10797
10798 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010799 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010800 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10801 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10802 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10803 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010804 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10805 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010806 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010807
10808 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10809 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10810 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10811 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010812 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10813 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010814
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010815 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010816
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010817 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010818 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010819 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10820 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010821 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10822 clients).
10823
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010824 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10825 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10826 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10827 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10828 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10829 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10830 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10831 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10832 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10833 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10834 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10835 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10836 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10837
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010838 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10839 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10840 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10841 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10842 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10843
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010844 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10845 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10846 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10847 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010848
10849 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10850 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10851 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10852 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10853 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10854 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10855 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10856 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10857 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10858
10859 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10860
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010861 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010862 a cert bundle.
10863
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010864 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010865 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10866 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10867 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10868 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10869 provide multi-cert support.
10870
10871 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10872
10873 Filename | CN | SAN
10874 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10875 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010876 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010877 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10878 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10879
10880 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10881 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10882 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10883 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010884 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10885 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10886 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010887
10888 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10889 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10890
10891 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10892 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10893 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10894
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010895crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010896 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010897 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010898 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010899 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010900
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010901crt-list <file>
10902 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010903 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10904 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010905
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010906 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10907
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010908 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10909 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010910 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010911 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010912
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010913 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10914 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10915 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10916 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10917 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10918 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10919 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10920 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010921
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010922 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010923 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010924 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10925 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10926 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010927
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010928 crt-list file example:
10929 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010930 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010931 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010932 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010933
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010934defer-accept
10935 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10936 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10937 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010938 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010939 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10940 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10941 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10942 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10943 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10944 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10945 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10946
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010947expose-fd listeners
10948 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10949 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010950 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10951 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010952 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010953
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010954force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010955 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010956 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010957 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010958 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010959
10960force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010961 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010962 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010963 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010964
10965force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010966 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010967 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010968 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010969
10970force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010971 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010972 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010973 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010974
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010975force-tlsv13
10976 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10977 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010978 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010979
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010980generate-certificates
10981 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10982 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10983 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10984 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10985 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10986 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10987 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10988 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10989 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10990 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10991 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10992
10993 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10994 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010995 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010996 certificate is used many times.
10997
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010998gid <gid>
10999 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11000 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11001 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11002 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11003 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11004
11005group <group>
11006 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11007 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11008 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11009 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11010 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11011
11012id <id>
11013 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11014 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11015 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11016 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11017
11018interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011019 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11020 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11021 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11022 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11023 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11024 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011025 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11026 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11027 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11028 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11029 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11030 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011031
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011032level <level>
11033 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11034 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11035 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011036 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011037 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11038 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11039 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011040 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011041 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011042 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011043 all counters).
11044
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011045severity-output <format>
11046 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11047 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11048 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11049 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11050 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11051 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11052 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11053 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11054 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11055 rfc5424 convention.
11056
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011057maxconn <maxconn>
11058 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11059 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11060 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11061 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11062 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11063 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11064 eat all memory.
11065
11066mode <mode>
11067 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11068 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11069 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11070 UNIX sockets.
11071
11072mss <maxseg>
11073 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11074 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11075 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11076 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11077 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11078 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11079 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11080 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11081 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11082 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11083 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11084
11085name <name>
11086 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11087 page.
11088
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011089namespace <name>
11090 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11091 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11092 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11093 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11094
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011095nice <nice>
11096 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11097 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11098 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11099 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11100 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11101 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11102 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11103 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11104 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11105 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11106 one for an RDP socket.
11107
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011108no-ca-names
11109 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11110 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11111
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011112no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011113 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011114 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011115 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011116 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011117 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11118 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011119
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011120no-tls-tickets
11121 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11122 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11123 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011124 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11125 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011126
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011127no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011128 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011129 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011130 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011131 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011132 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11133 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011134
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011135no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011136 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011137 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011138 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011139 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011140 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11141 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011142
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011143no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011144 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011145 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011146 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011147 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011148 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11149 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011150
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011151no-tlsv13
11152 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11153 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11154 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11155 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011156 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11157 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011158
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011159npn <protocols>
11160 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11161 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11162 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011163 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011164 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011165 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11166 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11167 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11168 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11169 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011170
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011171prefer-client-ciphers
11172 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11173 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11174 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011175 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11176 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11177 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011178
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011179process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011180 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011181 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011182 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011183 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11184 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11185 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11186 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011187 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011188 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11189 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11190 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11191 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11192 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011193
11194 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11195
11196 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11197 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11198 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11199 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11200 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11201 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11202 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11203 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011204
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011205proto <name>
11206 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11207 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11208 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11209 in haproxy -vv.
11210 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11211 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011212 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011213 h2" on the bind line.
11214
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011215ssl
11216 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011217 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011218 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11219 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011220 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11221 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011222
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011223ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11224 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11225 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11226 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11227
11228ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11229 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11230 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11231 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11232
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011233strict-sni
11234 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11235 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11236 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11237 See the "crt" option for more information.
11238
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011239tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011240 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011241 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11242 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011243 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011244 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11245 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11246 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11247 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11248 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11249 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11250 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11251
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011252tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011253 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011254 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11255 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11256 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11257 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11258 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11259 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11260 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011261 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11262 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11263 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011264
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011265tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11266 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011267 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11268 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11269 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11270 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11271 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11272 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11273 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11274 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11275 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11276 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011277 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11278 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11279
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011280transparent
11281 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11282 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11283 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11284 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11285 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11286 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11287 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11288 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11289 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11290 so check for support with your vendor.
11291
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011292v4v6
11293 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11294 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11295 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11296 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011297 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011298
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011299v6only
11300 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11301 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11302 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011303 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11304 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011305
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011306uid <uid>
11307 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11308 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11309 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11310 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11311 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11312
11313user <user>
11314 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11315 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11316 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11317 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11318 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11319
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011320verify [none|optional|required]
11321 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11322 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11323 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11324 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11325 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011326 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11327 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11328 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11329 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011330
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200113315.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011332------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011333
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011334The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11335which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11336arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11337settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11338after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11339Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11340address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011342 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011343 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011344
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011345Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11346keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11347
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011348The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011349
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011350addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011351 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011352 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11353 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11354 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11355 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11356 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011357
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011358agent-check
11359 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011360 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011361 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11362 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11363 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011364
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011365 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011366 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011367 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11368 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11369 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011370
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011371 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11372 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11373 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11374 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11375 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011376
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011377 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011378 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011379
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011380 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11381 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11382 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011383
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011384 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11385 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11386 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011387
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011388 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11389 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11390 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11391 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11392 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011393 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011394 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011395
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011396 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11397 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011398
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011399 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11400 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11401 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11402 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11403 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11404 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11405 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11406 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11407 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011408
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011409 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11410 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011411 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11412 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11413 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011414 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011415
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011416 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011417 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011418
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011419agent-send <string>
11420 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11421 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11422 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11423 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11424 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11425
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011426agent-inter <delay>
11427 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11428 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11429
11430 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11431 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11432 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11433 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11434 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11435 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11436 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11437 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11438 of backends use the same servers.
11439
11440 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11441
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011442agent-addr <addr>
11443 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11444
11445 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11446 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11447 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11448 hostname, it will be resolved.
11449
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011450agent-port <port>
11451 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11452
11453 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11454
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011455allow-0rtt
11456 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011457 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11458 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011459
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011460alpn <protocols>
11461 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11462 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11463 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011464 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011465 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11466 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11467 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11468 now obsolete NPN extension.
11469 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11470 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11471
11472 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11473
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011474backup
11475 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11476 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11477 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11478 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011479 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11480 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011481
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011482ca-file <cafile>
11483 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11484 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11485 server's certificate.
11486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011487check
11488 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011489 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11490 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11491 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11492 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11493 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11494 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11495 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011496 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11497 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011498 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11499 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011500
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011501check-send-proxy
11502 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11503 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11504 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11505 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11506 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11507 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11508 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11509
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011510check-alpn <protocols>
11511 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11512 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11513 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11514
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011515check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011516 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011517 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11518 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011519
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011520check-ssl
11521 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11522 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11523 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11524 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011525 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011526 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11527 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011528 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011529 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11530 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011531
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011532check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011533 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011534 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11535 for normal traffic.
11536
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011537ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011538 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11539 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11540 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011541 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11542 information and recommendations see e.g.
11543 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11544 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11545 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011546
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011547ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11548 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11549 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11550 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11551 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011552 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11553 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11554 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011555
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011556cookie <value>
11557 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11558 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11559 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11560 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11561 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11562 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11563 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11564
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011565crl-file <crlfile>
11566 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11567 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11568 to verify server's certificate.
11569
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011570crt <cert>
11571 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11572 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11573 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11574 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11575 certificate request.
11576
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011577disabled
11578 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11579 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11580 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11581 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11582 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011583 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011584
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011585enabled
11586 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11587 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11588 default value.
11589 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11590 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011591
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011592error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011593 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11594 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11595 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011596
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011597 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011598
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011599fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011600 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11601 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11602 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11603
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011604force-sslv3
11605 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11606 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011607 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011608 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011609
11610force-tlsv10
11611 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011612 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011613 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011614
11615force-tlsv11
11616 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011617 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011618 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011619
11620force-tlsv12
11621 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011622 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011623 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011624
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011625force-tlsv13
11626 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11627 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011628 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011629
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011630id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011631 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11632 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11633 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011634
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011635init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11636 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11637 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011638 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011639 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11640 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11641 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11642 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11643 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11644 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11645 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11646 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11647 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011648 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011649 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11650 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11651 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11652 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11653 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11654 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011655 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011656
11657 Example:
11658 defaults
11659 # never fail on address resolution
11660 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011662inter <delay>
11663fastinter <delay>
11664downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011665 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11666 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11667 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11668 between checks depending on the server state :
11669
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011670 Server state | Interval used
11671 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11672 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11673 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11674 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11675 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11676 or yet unchecked. |
11677 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11678 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11679 | "inter" otherwise.
11680 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011681
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011682 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11683 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11684 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11685 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011686 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11687 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11688 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11689 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11690 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011691
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011692maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011693 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11694 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011695 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
11696 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011697 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11698 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11699 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11700 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11701
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011702 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
11703 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
11704 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
11705 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
11706 than 50 concurrent requests.
11707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011708maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011709 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11710 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11711 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11712 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11713 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11714 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11715 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11716
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011717max-reuse <count>
11718 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11719 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11720 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11721 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11722 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11723 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11724 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11725 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011727minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011728 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11729 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11730 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11731 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11732 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11733 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011734 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011735 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011736
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011737namespace <name>
11738 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11739 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11740 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11741 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11742
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011743no-agent-check
11744 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11745 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11746 default value.
11747 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11748 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11749
11750no-backup
11751 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11752 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11753 default value.
11754 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11755 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11756
11757no-check
11758 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11759 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11760 default value.
11761 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11762 "default-server" "check" setting.
11763
11764no-check-ssl
11765 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11766 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11767 default value.
11768 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11769 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11770
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011771no-send-proxy
11772 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11773 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11774 default value.
11775 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11776 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11777
11778no-send-proxy-v2
11779 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11780 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11781 default value.
11782 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11783 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11784
11785no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11786 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11787 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11788 default value.
11789 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11790 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11791
11792no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11793 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11794 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11795 default value.
11796 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11797 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11798
11799no-ssl
11800 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11801 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11802 default value.
11803 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11804 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11805
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011806no-ssl-reuse
11807 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11808 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11809 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11810 and for paranoid users.
11811
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011812no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011813 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11814 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011815 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011816
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011817 Supported in default-server: No
11818
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011819no-tls-tickets
11820 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11821 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11822 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011823 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11824 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011825 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011826
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011827no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011828 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011829 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11830 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011831 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11832 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011833 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011834
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011835 Supported in default-server: No
11836
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011837no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011838 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011839 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11840 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011841 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11842 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011843 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011844
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011845 Supported in default-server: No
11846
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011847no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011848 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011849 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11850 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011851 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11852 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011853 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011854
11855 Supported in default-server: No
11856
11857no-tlsv13
11858 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11859 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11860 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11861 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11862 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011863 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011864
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011865 Supported in default-server: No
11866
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011867no-verifyhost
11868 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11869 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11870 default value.
11871 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11872 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011873
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020011874no-tfo
11875 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
11876 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11877 default value.
11878 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11879 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
11880
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011881non-stick
11882 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11883 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11884 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11885
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011886npn <protocols>
11887 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11888 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11889 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011890 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011891 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11892 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11893 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11894
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011895observe <mode>
11896 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11897 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11898 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11899 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11900 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11901 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011902 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011903
11904 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11905
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011906on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011907 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11908 Currently, four modes are available:
11909 - fastinter: force fastinter
11910 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11911 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11912 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11913 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11914
11915 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11916
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011917on-marked-down <action>
11918 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11919 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011920 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11921 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11922 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11923 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11924 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11925 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11926 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11927 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011928
11929 Actions are disabled by default
11930
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011931on-marked-up <action>
11932 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11933 Currently one action is available:
11934 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11935 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11936 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11937 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011938 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11939 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011940 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11941 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11942
11943 Actions are disabled by default
11944
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010011945pool-max-conn <max>
11946 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
11947 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
11948 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
11949 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
11950 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
11951 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
11952
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011953pool-purge-delay <delay>
11954 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010011955 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020011956 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011957
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011958port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011959 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11960 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11961 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11962 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11963 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11964 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11965
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011966proto <name>
11967
11968 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
11969 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
11970 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
11971 reported in haproxy -vv.
11972 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11973 protocol for all connections established to this server.
11974
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011975redir <prefix>
11976 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11977 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11978 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11979 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11980 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11981 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11982 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11983 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011984 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011985 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011986 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11987 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11988 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11989 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11990
11991 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011993rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011994 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11995 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11996 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11997
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020011998resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
11999 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12000 server.
12001
12002 Available options:
12003
12004 * allow-dup-ip
12005 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12006 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12007 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12008 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12009 For such case, simply enable this option.
12010 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12011
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012012 * ignore-weight
12013 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12014 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12015 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12016
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012017 * prevent-dup-ip
12018 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12019 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12020 same fqdn.
12021 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12022
12023 Example:
12024 backend b_myapp
12025 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12026 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12027 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12028
12029 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12030 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12031 it
12032 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12033 different address
12034
12035 Default value: not set
12036
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012037resolve-prefer <family>
12038 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12039 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12040 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12041 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12042
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012043 Default value: ipv6
12044
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012045 Example:
12046
12047 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012048
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012049resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012050 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012051 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012052 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012053 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12054 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012055 configured network, another address is selected.
12056
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012057 Example:
12058
12059 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012060
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012061resolvers <id>
12062 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12063 hostname.
12064
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012065 Example:
12066
12067 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012068
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012069 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012070
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012071send-proxy
12072 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12073 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12074 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12075 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012076 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12077 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12078 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12079 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12080 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12081 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12082 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12083 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12084 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12085 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012086 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12087 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012088
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012089send-proxy-v2
12090 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12091 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12092 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12093 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012094 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12095 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12096 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12097 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012098
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012099proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12100 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12101 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012102 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12103 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012104 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12105 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012106 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012107
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012108send-proxy-v2-ssl
12109 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12110 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12111 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12112 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12113 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12114 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12115 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012116 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12117 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012118
12119send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12120 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12121 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12122 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12123 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12124 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12125 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12126 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12127 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012128 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12129 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012130
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012131slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012132 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12133 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12134 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12135 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12136 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12137 parameters :
12138
12139 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12140 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12141
12142 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12143 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12144 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12145 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12146
12147 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12148 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12149 seen as failed.
12150
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012151sni <expression>
12152 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12153 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12154 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12155 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012156 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12157 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012158 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012159 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12160 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012161
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012162source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012163source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012164source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012165 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12166 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12167 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12168 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12169
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012170 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12171 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12172 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12173 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12174 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12175 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12176 server.
12177
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012178 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12179 specifying the source address without port(s).
12180
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012181ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012182 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12183 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12184 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12185 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12186 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12187 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012188 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12189 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012190
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012191ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12192 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12193 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12194 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12195
12196ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12197 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12198 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12199 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12200
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012201ssl-reuse
12202 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12203 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12204 default value.
12205 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12206 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12207
12208stick
12209 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12210 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12211 default value.
12212 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12213 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012214
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012215socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012216 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012217 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12218 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12219
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012220tcp-ut <delay>
12221 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12222 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12223 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012224 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012225 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12226 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12227 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12228 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12229 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12230 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12231 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12232 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12233 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12234
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012235tfo
12236 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12237 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12238 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12239 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12240 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012241 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012242
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012243track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012244 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12245 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12246 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12247 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012248 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12249
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012250tls-tickets
12251 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12252 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12253 default value.
12254 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12255 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012256
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012257verify [none|required]
12258 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012259 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012260 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12261 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012262 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012263 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12264 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12265 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12266 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12267 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12268 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12269 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12270 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012271
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012272verifyhost <hostname>
12273 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012274 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12275 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12276 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12277 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12278 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12279 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12280 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12281 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012283weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012284 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12285 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12286 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012287 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12288 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12289 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12290 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12291 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12292 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012293
12294
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122955.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12296-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012297
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012298HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12299using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12300configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012301This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12302can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12303workload.
12304This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12305resolution at run time.
12306Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12307carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12308
12309
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123105.3.1. Global overview
12311----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012312
12313As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12314different steps of the process life:
12315
12316 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12317 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12318 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12319
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012320 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12321 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012322
12323A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12324 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12325 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12326 resolution to know this new IP.
12327
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012328When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012329HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012330SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12331from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12332will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12333will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012334
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012335A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012336 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012337 first valid response.
12338
12339 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12340 servers return an error.
12341
12342
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123435.3.2. The resolvers section
12344----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012345
12346This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012347HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12348contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012349
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012350When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12351uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12352is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12353answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12354
12355When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012356used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012357
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012358 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12359 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12360 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012361
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012362 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12363 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012364
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012365 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12366 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12367 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012368
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012369For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12370following scenarios are possible:
12371
12372 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12373 ignored
12374
12375 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12376 applied
12377
12378 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12379 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12380
12381 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12382 retries the query with a new type
12383
12384 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12385 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012386
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012387As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12388a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012389<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012390
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012391
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012392resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012393 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012394
12395A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12396
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012397accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012398 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012399 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012400 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12401 by RFC 6891)
12402
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012403 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12404
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012405nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12406 DNS server description:
12407 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12408 <ip> : IP address of the server
12409 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12410
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012411parse-resolv-conf
12412 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12413 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12414 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12415
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012416hold <status> <period>
12417 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12418 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012419 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012420 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012421 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12422 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12423 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12424
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012425 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012426
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012427resolve_retries <nb>
12428 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12429 giving up.
12430 Default value: 3
12431
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012432 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12433 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12434 type.
12435
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012436timeout <event> <time>
12437 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12438 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12439 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012440 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12441 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012442 Default value: 1s
12443 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012444 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012445 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012446 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12447 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12448
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012449 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012450
12451 resolvers mydns
12452 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12453 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012454 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012455 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012456 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012457 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012458 hold other 30s
12459 hold refused 30s
12460 hold nx 30s
12461 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012462 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012463 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012464
12465
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200124666. Cache
12467---------
12468
12469HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12470(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12471RAM.
12472
12473The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12474this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12475
12476If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12477independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12478when we try to allocate a new one.
12479
12480The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12481
12482It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12483"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12484for more details.
12485
12486When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12487replaced by "<CACHE>".
12488
12489
124906.1. Limitation
12491----------------
12492
12493The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12494
12495- If the response is not a 200
12496- If the response contains a Vary header
12497- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12498- If the response is not cacheable
12499
12500- If the request is not a GET
12501- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12502- If the request contains an Authorization header
12503
12504
125056.2. Setup
12506-----------
12507
12508To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12509the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12510
12511
125126.2.1. Cache section
12513---------------------
12514
12515cache <name>
12516 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12517 size of cache is mandatory.
12518
12519total-max-size <megabytes>
12520 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12521 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12522
12523max-object-size <bytes>
12524 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12525 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12526 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12527
12528max-age <seconds>
12529 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12530 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12531 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12532 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12533 default.
12534
12535
125366.2.2. Proxy section
12537---------------------
12538
12539http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12540 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12541 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12542 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12543 after this one.
12544
12545http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12546 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12547 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12548 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12549 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12550
12551
12552Example:
12553
12554 backend bck1
12555 mode http
12556
12557 http-request cache-use foobar
12558 http-response cache-store foobar
12559 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12560
12561 cache foobar
12562 total-max-size 4
12563 max-age 240
12564
12565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125667. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12567----------------------------------
12568
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012569HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012570client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12571The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12572these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12573but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12574data called patterns.
12575
12576
125777.1. ACL basics
12578---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012579
12580The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12581content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12582from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12583simple :
12584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012585 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012586 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012587 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12588 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012590The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12591adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012592
12593In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012595 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012596
12597This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12598Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12599and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012600an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12601conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12602as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12603are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012604
12605ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12606'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12607which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12608
12609There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12610performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012612The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12613specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12614this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012615methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12616ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012617
12618Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12619 - boolean
12620 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12621 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12622 - string
12623 - data block
12624
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012625Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12626converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12627would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12628The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12629which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12630
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012631Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12632keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12633fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12634which are summarized in the table below :
12635
12636 +---------------------+-----------------+
12637 | Sample or converter | Default |
12638 | output type | matching method |
12639 +---------------------+-----------------+
12640 | boolean | bool |
12641 +---------------------+-----------------+
12642 | integer | int |
12643 +---------------------+-----------------+
12644 | ip | ip |
12645 +---------------------+-----------------+
12646 | string | str |
12647 +---------------------+-----------------+
12648 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12649 +---------------------+-----------------+
12650
12651Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12652matching method, see below.
12653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012654The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12655 - boolean
12656 - integer or integer range
12657 - IP address / network
12658 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12659 - regular expression
12660 - hex block
12661
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012662The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12663
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012664 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12665 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012666 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012667 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012668 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012669 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012670 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012672The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12673read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12674if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12675lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12676will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12677beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12678a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12679lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12680exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12681
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012682The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12683parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12684ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12685a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12686check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12687
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012688The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12689socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12690file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012692Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12693loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12694
12695 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12696
12697In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12698the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12699case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12700as well.
12701
12702The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12703sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12704do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12705methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12706is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012707obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012708followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12709default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12710that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12711string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12712
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012713The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12714By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12715string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12716resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12717server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012718waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012719flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12720function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012722There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12723sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12724be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012725
12726 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12727 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012728 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12729 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12730 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12731 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012732
12733 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12734 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012735 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012736
12737 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012738 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012739
12740 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012741 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012742
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012743 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012744 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12745
12746 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12747 binary or string samples.
12748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012749 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12750 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012752 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12753 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12754 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012756 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12757 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012759 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12760 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012762 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12763 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012765 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12766 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012767 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012769 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12770 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12771 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012772
12773For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12774request, it is possible to do :
12775
12776 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12777
12778In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12779buffer, one would use the following acl :
12780
12781 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12782
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012783On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12784possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12785
12786 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012788All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12789criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12790method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12791to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12792criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12793the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012795If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012796the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12797For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012799 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12800 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12801 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12802 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012803
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012804
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012805The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12806types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12807combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12808brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12809default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012811 +-------------------------------------------------+
12812 | Input sample type |
12813 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012814 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012815 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12816 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12817 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012818 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012819 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012820 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012821 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012822 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012823 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012824 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012825 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012826 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012827 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012828 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012829 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012830 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012831 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012832 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012833 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012834 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012835 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012836 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012837 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012838 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012839 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12840 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12841 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012842
12843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128447.1.1. Matching booleans
12845------------------------
12846
12847In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12848Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12849When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12850that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12851
12852Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12853return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12854"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12855
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128577.1.2. Matching integers
12858------------------------
12859
12860Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12861enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12862to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12863
12864Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12865matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12866lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012867
12868For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12869unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12870representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12871
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012872As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12873two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12874instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12875ranges and operators.
12876
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012877For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012878operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12879Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12880of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012881
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012882Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012883
12884 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12885 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12886 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12887 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12888 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12889
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012890For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012891
12892 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12893
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012894This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12895
12896 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12897
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128997.1.3. Matching strings
12900-----------------------
12901
12902String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12903different forms :
12904
12905 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012906 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012907
12908 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012909 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012910
12911 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12912 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12913
12914 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12915 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12916
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012917 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012918 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12919 matches.
12920
12921 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12922 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12923 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012924
12925String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12926exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12927characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12928string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12929to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012930before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012931
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010012932Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
12933(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
12934Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
12935
12936Example:
12937 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
12938 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
12939
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129417.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12942---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012943
12944Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12945they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12946possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12947passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12948the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012949the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12950match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012951
12952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129537.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12954-------------------------------------
12955
12956It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12957not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12958a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12959to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12960digits may be used upper or lower case.
12961
12962Example :
12963 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12964 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12965
12966
129677.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12968---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012969
12970IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12971netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12972within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012973host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012974difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12975at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12976does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12977parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012978
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012979The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12980abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12981
12982 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12983 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12984 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12985 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12986 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12987 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12988 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12989 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12990
12991Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12992192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12993
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012994IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12995Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12996trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12997IPv6 patterns.
12998
12999HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13000following situations :
13001 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13002 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13003 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13004 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13005 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13006 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13007 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13008 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13009 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13010 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013012
130137.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13014----------------------------------
13015
13016Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13017combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13018
13019 - AND (implicit)
13020 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13021 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013023A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013025 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013027Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13028indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013030For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13031"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13032requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13033is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13034
13035 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013036 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13037 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13038 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013039
13040To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13041and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13042
13043 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13044 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13045 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13046 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13047
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013048 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013049 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13050 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13051 use_backend www if host_www
13052
13053It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13054expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13055be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13056the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13057
13058 The following rule :
13059
13060 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013061 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013062
13063 Can also be written that way :
13064
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013065 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013066
13067It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13068to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13069simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13070sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13071good use is the following :
13072
13073 With named ACLs :
13074
13075 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13076 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13077 monitor fail if site_dead
13078
13079 With anonymous ACLs :
13080
13081 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13082
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013083See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13084keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013085
13086
130877.3. Fetching samples
13088---------------------
13089
13090Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13091against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13092sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13093ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13094of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13095available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13096
13097This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13098Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13099compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13100deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13101
13102The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13103matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13104method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13105indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13106
13107As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13108when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13109mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13110the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13111ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13112
13113Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13114multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13115when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013116incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13117are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013118is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13119all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13120
13121Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13122 - name
13123 - name(arg1)
13124 - name(arg1,arg2)
13125
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013126
131277.3.1. Converters
13128-----------------
13129
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013130Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13131of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13132is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13133was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013134has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013135unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13136
13137These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13138sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13139the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013140support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013141
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013142A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13143support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13144supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13145(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13146bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013148The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013149
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001315051d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13151 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13152 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13153 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13154 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13155 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13156
13157 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013158 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13159 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013160 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13161 frontend http-in
13162 bind *:8081
13163 default_backend servers
13164 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13165 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13166
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013167add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013168 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013169 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013170 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13171 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013172 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013173 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13174 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13175 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13176 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013177 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013178 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013179
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013180aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13181 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13182 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13183 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13184 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13185 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13186 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13187
13188 Example:
13189 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13190 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13191
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013192and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013193 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013194 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013195 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13196 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013197 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013198 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13199 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13200 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13201 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013202 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013203 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013204
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013205b64dec
13206 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13207 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13208
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013209base64
13210 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013211 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013212 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13213
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013214bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013215 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013216 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013217 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013218 presence of a flag).
13219
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013220bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13221 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13222 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013223 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013224
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013225concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13226 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13227 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13228 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13229 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13230 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13231 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13232 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13233 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13234 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13235 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013236 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013237 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013238 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013239
13240 Example:
13241 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13242 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13243 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13244 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13245
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013246cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013247 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13248 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013249
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013250crc32([<avalanche>])
13251 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13252 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13253 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13254 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13255 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13256 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13257 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13258 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13259 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13260 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013261 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13262
13263crc32c([<avalanche>])
13264 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13265 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13266 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13267 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13268 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13269 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13270 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13271 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013272
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013273da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013274 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13275 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13276 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13277 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013278 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013279 configuration language.
13280
13281 Example:
13282 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013283 bind *:8881
13284 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013285 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013286
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013287debug
13288 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13289 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13290 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13291
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013292div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013293 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13294 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013295 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013296 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13297 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013298 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013299 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13300 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13301 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13302 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013303 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013304 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013305
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013306djb2([<avalanche>])
13307 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13308 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13309 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13310 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13311 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13312 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13313 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013314 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13315 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013316
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013317even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013318 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013319 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13320
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013321field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13322 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13323 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13324 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13325 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13326 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13327 fields.
13328
13329 Example :
13330 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13331 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13332 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13333 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13334 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013335
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013336hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013337 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013338 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013339 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013340 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013341
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013342hex2i
13343 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013344 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013345
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013346http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013347 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13348 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013349 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13350 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13351 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13352 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13353 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13354 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13355 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13356 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013357
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013358in_table(<table>)
13359 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13360 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13361 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013362 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013363 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13364
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013365ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13366 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013367 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013368 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13369 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13370 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13371 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13372 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013373
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013374json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013375 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013376 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013377 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013378 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13379 of errors:
13380 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13381 bytes, ...)
13382 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13383 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13384
13385 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13386 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13387 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13388 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13389 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13390 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013391 - "ascii" : never fails;
13392 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13393 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013394 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013395 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013396 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13397 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13398
13399 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013400 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013401
13402 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013403 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013404 capture request header user-agent len 150
13405 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013406
13407 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13408 GET / HTTP/1.0
13409 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13410
13411 Output log:
13412 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13413
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013414language(<value>[,<default>])
13415 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13416 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13417 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13418 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13419 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13420 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13421 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13422 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13423 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013424 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013425 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13426 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013427
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013428 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013429
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013430 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13431 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013432
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013433 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13434 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13435 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13436 use_backend spanish if es
13437 use_backend french if fr
13438 use_backend english if en
13439 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013440
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013441length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013442 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13443 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13444 type. The result is of type integer.
13445
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013446lower
13447 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13448 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13449 type. The result is of type string.
13450
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013451ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13452 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13453 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13454 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13455 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13456 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13457 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13458
13459 Example :
13460
13461 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013462 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013463 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13464
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013465map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13466map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13467map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13468 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13469 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13470 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13471 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13472 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13473 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13474 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13475 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013476
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013477 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13478 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13479 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013480
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013481 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013482 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013483
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013484 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13485 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13486 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13487 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013488 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13489 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013490 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13491 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13492 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13493 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13494 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13495 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13496 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13497 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013498 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13499 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13500 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013501 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13502 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13503 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13504 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13505 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013506
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013507 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13508 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13509 the corresponding match text.
13510
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013511 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13512 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13513 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13514 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13515 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013516
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013517 Example :
13518
13519 # this is a comment and is ignored
13520 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13521 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13522 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13523 | | | `---------- value
13524 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13525 | `---------------------------- key
13526 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13527
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013528mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013529 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13530 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013531 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013532 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013533 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013534 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13535 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13536 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13537 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013538 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013539 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013540
13541mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013542 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013543 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13544 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013545 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013546 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013547 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013548 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13549 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13550 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13551 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013552 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013553 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013554
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013555nbsrv
13556 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13557 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13558 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13559 map lookup.
13560
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013561neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013562 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13563 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13564 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13565 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013566
13567not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013568 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013569 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013570 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013571 absence of a flag).
13572
13573odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013574 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013575 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13576
13577or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013578 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013579 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013580 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13581 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013582 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013583 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13584 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13585 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13586 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013587 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013588 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013589
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013590protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13591 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13592 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13593 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13594 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13595 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13596 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13597 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13598 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13599 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13600 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13601 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13602
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013603regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013604 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13605 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13606 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13607 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13608 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13609 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13610 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13611 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13612 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13613 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013614 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13615 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13616 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13617 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013618
13619 Example :
13620
13621 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13622 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13623 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13624 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13625
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013626capture-req(<id>)
13627 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13628 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13629
13630 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013631 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13632 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013633
13634capture-res(<id>)
13635 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13636 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13637
13638 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013639 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13640 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013641
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013642sdbm([<avalanche>])
13643 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13644 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13645 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13646 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13647 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13648 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13649 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013650 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13651 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013652
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013653set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013654 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13655 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13656 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013657 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013658 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13659 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013660 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013661 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13662 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013663 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013664 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013665
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013666sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013667 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013668 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13669
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013670sha2([<bits>])
13671 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13672 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13673
13674 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13675 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13676
13677 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13678 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13679
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020013680srv_queue
13681 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
13682 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
13683 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
13684 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
13685 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
13686
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013687strcmp(<var>)
13688 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13689 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13690 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13691 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13692 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13693 shorter).
13694
13695 Example :
13696
13697 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13698 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13699 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13700
13701
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013702sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013703 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13704 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013705 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013706 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13707 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013708 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013709 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13710 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013711 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013712 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13713 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013714 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013715 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013716
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013717table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13718 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13719 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13720 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13721 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13722 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13723 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13724
13725
13726table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13727 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13728 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13729 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13730 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13731 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13732 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13733
13734table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13735 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13736 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013737 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013738 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13739 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13740
13741table_conn_cur(<table>)
13742 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13743 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13744 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13745 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13746 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13747
13748table_conn_rate(<table>)
13749 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13750 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13751 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13752 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13753 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13754
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013755table_gpt0(<table>)
13756 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13757 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13758 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13759 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13760 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13761
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013762table_gpc0(<table>)
13763 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13764 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13765 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13766 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13767 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13768
13769table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13770 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13771 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13772 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13773 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13774 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13775 sample fetch keyword.
13776
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013777table_gpc1(<table>)
13778 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13779 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13780 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13781 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13782 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13783
13784table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13785 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13786 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13787 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13788 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13789 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13790 sample fetch keyword.
13791
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013792table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13793 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13794 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013795 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013796 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13797 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13798
13799table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13800 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13801 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13802 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13803 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13804 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13805 keyword.
13806
13807table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13808 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13809 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013810 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013811 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13812 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13813
13814table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13815 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13816 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13817 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13818 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13819 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13820 keyword.
13821
13822table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13823 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13824 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013825 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013826 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13827 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13828 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13829 keyword.
13830
13831table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13832 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13833 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013834 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013835 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13836 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13837 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13838 keyword.
13839
13840table_server_id(<table>)
13841 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13842 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13843 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13844 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13845 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13846 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13847
13848table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13849 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13850 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013851 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013852 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13853 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13854 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13855 keyword.
13856
13857table_sess_rate(<table>)
13858 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13859 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13860 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13861 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13862 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13863 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13864 keyword.
13865
13866table_trackers(<table>)
13867 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13868 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13869 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13870 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13871 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13872 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13873 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13874 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13875 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13876 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13877
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013878upper
13879 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13880 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13881 type. The result is of type string.
13882
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013883url_dec
13884 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13885 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13886
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013887ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013888 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013889 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
13890 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
13891 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013892 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13893 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13894 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13895 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013896 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013897 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13898 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013899
13900 Example:
13901 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
13902 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
13903
13904 message Point {
13905 int32 latitude = 1;
13906 int32 longitude = 2;
13907 }
13908
13909 message PPoint {
13910 Point point = 59;
13911 }
13912
13913 message Rectangle {
13914 // One corner of the rectangle.
13915 PPoint lo = 48;
13916 // The other corner of the rectangle.
13917 PPoint hi = 49;
13918 }
13919
13920 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
13921 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
13922 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
13923
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013924 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13925 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013926 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013927 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
13928
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013929 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013930
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013931 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013932
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013933 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013934 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13935 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
13936
13937 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
13938 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
13939 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
13940
13941 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
13942 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
13943 interpret the previous binary sample.
13944
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013945
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013946unset-var(<var name>)
13947 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13948 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13949 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13950 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13951 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13952 response),
13953 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13954 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13955 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13956 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13957
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013958utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13959 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13960 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13961 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13962 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13963 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13964 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13965
13966 Example :
13967
13968 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013969 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013970 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13971
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013972word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13973 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13974 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13975 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13976 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13977 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13978
13979 Example :
13980 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13981 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13982 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13983 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13984 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013985
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013986wt6([<avalanche>])
13987 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13988 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13989 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13990 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13991 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13992 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13993 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013994 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13995 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013996
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013997xor(<value>)
13998 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013999 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014000 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014001 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014002 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014003 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14004 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014005 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014006 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14007 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014008 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014009 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014010
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014011xxh32([<seed>])
14012 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14013 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14014 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14015 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14016 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14017 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14018 as cryptographically secure.
14019
14020xxh64([<seed>])
14021 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14022 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14023 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14024 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14025 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14026 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14027 as cryptographically secure.
14028
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014029
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140307.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014031--------------------------------------------
14032
14033A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14034not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14035"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14036The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14037
14038always_false : boolean
14039 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14040 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14041
14042always_true : boolean
14043 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14044 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14045
14046avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014047 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014048 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14049 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14050 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14051 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14052 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14053 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14054 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14055 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14056 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14057 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14058 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14059 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14060 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014062be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014063 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14064 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14065 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14066 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014067 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14068
14069be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14070 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14071 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14072 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14073 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14074 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014075 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14076 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014077
14078 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14079 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14080 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014082be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14083 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14084 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14085 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014086 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014087 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14088 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014089
14090 Example :
14091 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14092 backend dynamic
14093 mode http
14094 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14095 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014096
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014097bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014098 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14099 of the string.
14100
14101bool(<bool>) : bool
14102 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14103 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014105connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14106 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014107 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014108 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14109 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014110
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014111 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014112 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014113 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14114
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014115 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14116 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014117
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014118 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014119 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014120 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014121 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014122 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014123 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014124 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014125
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014126 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14127 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014128 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014129 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014130
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014131cpu_calls : integer
14132 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14133 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14134 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14135 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14136 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14137 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14138
14139cpu_ns_avg : integer
14140 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14141 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14142 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14143 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14144 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14145 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14146 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14147 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14148 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14149 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14150 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14151
14152cpu_ns_tot : integer
14153 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14154 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14155 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14156 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14157 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14158 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14159 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14160 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14161 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14162 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14163 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14164 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14165 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14166
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014167date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014168 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014169
14170 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14171 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14172 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014173 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14174
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014175 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14176 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14177 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14178 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14179 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14180
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014181 Example :
14182
14183 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14184 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014185
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014186 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14187 # millisecond granularity
14188 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14189
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014190date_us : integer
14191 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14192 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14193 from the same timeval structure.
14194
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014195distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14196 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14197 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14198 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14199 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14200 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14201 list of supported tokens.
14202
14203distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14204 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14205 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14206 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14207 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14208 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14209 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14210 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14211 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14212 supported tokens.
14213
14214 Example :
14215 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14216 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14217 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14218 # send large files to the big farm
14219 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14220
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014221env(<name>) : string
14222 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14223 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14224 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14225 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14226 certain way.
14227
14228 Examples :
14229 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14230 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14231
14232 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14233 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014235fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14236 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014237 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14238 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014239 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14240 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014241 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014242 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14243 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014244
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014245fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14246 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14247 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14248 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014250fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14251 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14252 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14253 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14254 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14255 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14256 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14257 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14258 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014259
14260 Example :
14261 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14262 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14263 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14264 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14265 frontend mail
14266 bind :25
14267 mode tcp
14268 maxconn 100
14269 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14270 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14271 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14272 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014273
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014274hostname : string
14275 Returns the system hostname.
14276
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014277int(<integer>) : signed integer
14278 Returns a signed integer.
14279
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014280ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14281 Returns an ipv4.
14282
14283ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14284 Returns an ipv6.
14285
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014286lat_ns_avg : integer
14287 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14288 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14289 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14290 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14291 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14292 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14293 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14294 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14295 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14296 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14297 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14298 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14299 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14300 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14301
14302lat_ns_tot : integer
14303 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14304 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14305 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14306 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14307 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14308 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14309 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14310 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14311 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14312 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14313 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14314 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14315 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14316 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14317 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14318 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14319 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14320 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14321 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14322
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014323meth(<method>) : method
14324 Returns a method.
14325
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014326nbproc : integer
14327 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14328 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14329 and debugging purposes.
14330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014331nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14332 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14333 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14334 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014335 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14336 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14337 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014338
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014339prio_class : integer
14340 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14341 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14342 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14343
14344prio_offset : integer
14345 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14346 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14347 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14348 set-priority-offset".
14349
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014350proc : integer
14351 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14352 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14353 debugging purposes.
14354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014355queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014356 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14357 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14358 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014359 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14360 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14361 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14362 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14363 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14364
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014365rand([<range>]) : integer
14366 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14367 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14368 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14369 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14370 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14371
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014372uuid([<version>]) : string
14373 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14374 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14375 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014377srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14378 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14379 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14380 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14381 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14382 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014383 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14384 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14385
14386srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14387 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14388 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14389 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14390 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14391 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14392 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14393 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14394
14395 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14396 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014397
14398srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14399 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14400 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14401 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014402 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014403 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14404 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14405 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14406
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014407srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14408 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14409 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14410 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14411 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14412 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14413 fetch methods.
14414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014415srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14416 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14417 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014418 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014419 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14420 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014421 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014422 overloading servers).
14423
14424 Example :
14425 # Redirect to a separate back
14426 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14427 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14428 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14429
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014430stopping : boolean
14431 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14432 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14433 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14434
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014435str(<string>) : string
14436 Returns a string.
14437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014438table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14439 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14440 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14441
14442table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14443 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14444 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14445 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14446
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014447thread : integer
14448 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14449 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14450 and debugging purposes.
14451
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014452var(<var-name>) : undefined
14453 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014454 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14455 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014456 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014457 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14458 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014459 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014460 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14461 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014462 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014463 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014464
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144657.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014466----------------------------------
14467
14468The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14469closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14470methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14471sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14472TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014473the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14474counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014475"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14476used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14477can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14478Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14479table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14480tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14481currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014482
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014483bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014484 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14485 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14486 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014488be_id : integer
14489 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14490 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14491
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014492be_name : string
14493 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14494 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014496dst : ip
14497 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14498 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14499 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14500 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014501 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14502 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14503 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14504 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14505 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14506 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014507
14508dst_conn : integer
14509 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14510 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14511 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14512 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14513 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14514 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14515 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14516 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014517
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014518dst_is_local : boolean
14519 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14520 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14521 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14522 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014523 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014524 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14525 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14526 it only once per connection.
14527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014528dst_port : integer
14529 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14530 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14531 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14532 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14533 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14534 an HTTP header.
14535
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014536fc_http_major : integer
14537 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14538 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14539 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14540
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014541fc_pp_authority : string
14542 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14543 if any.
14544
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014545fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14546 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14547 header.
14548
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014549fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14550 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14551 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14552 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14553 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14554 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14555 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14556
14557fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14558 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14559 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14560 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14561 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14562 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14563 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14564
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014565fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014566 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14567 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14568 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14569 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14570
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014571fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014572 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14573 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14574 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14575 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14576
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014577fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014578 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14579 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14580 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14581 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14582
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014583fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014584 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14585 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14586 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14587 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14588
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014589fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014590 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14591 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14592 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14593 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14594
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014595fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014596 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14597 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14598 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14599 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14600
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014601fe_defbe : string
14602 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14603 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014605fe_id : integer
14606 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014607 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014608 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14609
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014610fe_name : string
14611 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14612 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14613 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14614
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014615sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014616sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14617sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14618sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014619 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14620 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14621 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14622
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014623sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014624sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14625sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14626sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014627 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14628 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14629 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14630
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014631sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014632sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14633sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14634sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014635 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14636 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014637 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14638 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14639 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014640
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014641 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014642 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14643 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014644 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14645 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14646 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014647 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14648 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14649
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014650sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14651sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14652sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14653sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14654 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14655 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14656 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14657 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14658 when a first ACL was verified.
14659
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014660sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014661sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14662sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14663sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014664 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014665 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14666
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014667sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014668sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14669sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14670sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014671 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14672 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14673 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14674
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014675sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014676sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14677sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14678sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014679 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14680 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14681 See also src_conn_rate.
14682
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014683sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014684sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14685sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14686sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014687 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014688 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014689
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014690sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14691sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14692sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14693sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14694 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14695 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14696
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014697sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14698sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14699sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14700sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14701 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14702 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14703
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014704sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014705sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14706sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14707sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014708 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14709 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14710 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014711 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14712 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14713 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014714
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014715sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14716sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14717sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14718sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14719 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14720 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14721 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14722 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14723 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14724 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14725
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014726sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014727sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14728sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14729sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014730 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014731 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14732 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14733
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014734sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014735sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14736sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14737sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014738 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14739 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14740 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14741 src_http_err_rate.
14742
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014743sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014744sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14745sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14746sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014747 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014748 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14749 src_http_req_cnt.
14750
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014751sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014752sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14753sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14754sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014755 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14756 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14757 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14758 src_http_req_rate.
14759
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014760sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014761sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14762sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14763sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014764 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014765 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14766 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14767 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14768 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014769
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014770 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014771 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14772 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014773 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14774
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014775sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14776sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14777sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14778sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14779 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14780 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14781 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14782 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14783 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14784
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014785sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014786sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14787sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14788sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014789 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14790 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14791 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014792
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014793sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014794sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14795sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14796sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014797 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14798 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14799 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014800
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014801sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014802sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14803sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14804sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014805 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014806 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14807 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14808 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014809 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014810 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14811
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014812sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014813sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14814sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14815sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014816 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14817 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14818 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14819 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14820 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014821 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014822
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014823sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014824sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14825sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14826sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014827 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14828 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14829 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14830
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014831sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014832sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14833sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14834sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014835 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14836 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014837 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014838 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14839 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014840 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14841 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14842 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014844so_id : integer
14845 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14846 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14847 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014849src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014850 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014851 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14852 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14853 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014854 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14855 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14856 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014857 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14858 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14859 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14860 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14861 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14862 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14863 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014864
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014865 Example:
14866 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14867 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014869src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14870 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14871 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14872 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014873 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014875src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14876 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14877 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014878 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014879 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014881src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14882 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14883 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14884 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14885 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14886 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14887 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014888
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014889 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014890 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14891 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14892 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14893 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014894 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014895 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14896 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14897
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014898src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14899 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14900 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14901 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14902 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14903 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14904 was verified.
14905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014906src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014907 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014908 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014909 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014910 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014912src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014913 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014914 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14915 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014916 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014918src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14919 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14920 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14921 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014922 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014924src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014925 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014926 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014927 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014928 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014929
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014930src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14931 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14932 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14933 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14934 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14935
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014936src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14937 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14938 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14939 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14940 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014942src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014943 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014944 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014945 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14946 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014947 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14948 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14949 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014950
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014951src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14952 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14953 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14954 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14955 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14956 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14957 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14958 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014960src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014961 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014962 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014963 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014964 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014965 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014967src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14968 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14969 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14970 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14971 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014972 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014974src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014975 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014976 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14977 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014978 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014980src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14981 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14982 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14983 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014984 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014985 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014987src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14988 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14989 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14990 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014991 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014992 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14993 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014994
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014995 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014996 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014997 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014998 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014999
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015000src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15001 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15002 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15003 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15004 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15005 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15006 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15007
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015008src_is_local : boolean
15009 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15010 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15011 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15012 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015013 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015014 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15015 once per connection.
15016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015017src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015018 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15019 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15020 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15021 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15022 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015024src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015025 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15026 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15027 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15028 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15029 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015031src_port : integer
15032 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15033 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15034 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15035 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015037src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015038 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015039 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15040 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15041 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015042 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015044src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15045 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15046 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15047 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15048 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015049 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015051src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15052 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15053 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15054 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15055 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15056 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15057 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15058 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15059 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015060
15061 Example :
15062 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15063 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15064 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15065 listen ssh
15066 bind :22
15067 mode tcp
15068 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015069 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015070 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015071 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015073srv_id : integer
15074 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15075 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15076 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015077
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015078srv_name : string
15079 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15080 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15081 debugging.
15082
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150837.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015084----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015086The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15087closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15088when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15089usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015090future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015091
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001509251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15093 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15094 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15095 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15096 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15097 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15098
15099 Example :
15100 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15101 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15102 # the request.
15103 frontend http-in
15104 bind *:8081
15105 default_backend servers
15106 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15107 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15108
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015109ssl_bc : boolean
15110 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15111 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15112 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15113
15114ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15115 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15116 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15117
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015118ssl_bc_alpn : string
15119 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15120 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015121 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015122 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15123 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15124 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15125 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15126 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15127 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15128
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015129ssl_bc_cipher : string
15130 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15131 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15132
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015133ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15134 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15135 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15136 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15137
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015138ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15139 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15140 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15141 session or a TLS ticket.
15142
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015143ssl_bc_npn : string
15144 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15145 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015146 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015147 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15148 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15149 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15150 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15151 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15152
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015153ssl_bc_protocol : string
15154 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15155 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15156
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015157ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015158 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015159 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15160 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015161
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015162ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15163 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15164 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15165 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15166
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015167ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15168 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15169 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15170 if session was reused or not.
15171
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015172ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15173 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15174 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15175 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15176 BoringSSL.
15177
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015178ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15179 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15180 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015182ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15183 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15184 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15185 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15186 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15187 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015189ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15190 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15191 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15192 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15193 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015194
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015195ssl_c_der : binary
15196 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15197 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15198 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015200ssl_c_err : integer
15201 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15202 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15203 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15204 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15205 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015207ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15208 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15209 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15210 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15211 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15212 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15213 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15214 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15215 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015217ssl_c_key_alg : string
15218 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15219 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15220 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015222ssl_c_notafter : string
15223 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15224 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15225 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015227ssl_c_notbefore : string
15228 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15229 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15230 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015232ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15233 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15234 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15235 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15236 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15237 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15238 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15239 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15240 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015242ssl_c_serial : binary
15243 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15244 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15245 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015247ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15248 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15249 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15250 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015251 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15252 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15253
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015254 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015255 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015257ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15258 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15259 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15260 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015262ssl_c_used : boolean
15263 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15264 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015266ssl_c_verify : integer
15267 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15268 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15269 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15270 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015272ssl_c_version : integer
15273 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15274 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015275
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015276ssl_f_der : binary
15277 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15278 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15279 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015281ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15282 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15283 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15284 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15285 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015286 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015287 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15288 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15289 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015291ssl_f_key_alg : string
15292 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15293 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15294 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015296ssl_f_notafter : string
15297 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15298 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15299 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015301ssl_f_notbefore : string
15302 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15303 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15304 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015306ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15307 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15308 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15309 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15310 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15311 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15312 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15313 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15314 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015316ssl_f_serial : binary
15317 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15318 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15319 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015320
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015321ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15322 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15323 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15324 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015326ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15327 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15328 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15329 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015331ssl_f_version : integer
15332 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15333 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15334
15335ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015336 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15337 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15338 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015340 Example :
15341 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15342 listen http-https
15343 bind :80
15344 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15345 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15346
15347ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15348 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15349 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15350
15351ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015352 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015353 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15354 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15355 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15356 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15357 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15358 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15359 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15360 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015362ssl_fc_cipher : string
15363 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15364 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015365
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015366ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15367 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15368 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015369 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015370
15371ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15372 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15373 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015374 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015375
15376ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15377 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15378 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15379 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015380 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015381 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015382
15383ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15384 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15385 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015386 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015387
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015388ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15389 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15390 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15391 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015393ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015394 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15395 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015396 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15397 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15398 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15399 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015400
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015401ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15402 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15403 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15404 wait until the handshake happened.
15405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015406ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15407 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015408 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15409 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015410 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015411 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015412
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015413ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015414 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015415 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15416 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015418ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015419 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015420 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15421 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15422 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15423 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15424 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15425 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15426 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015428ssl_fc_protocol : string
15429 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15430 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015431
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015432ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015433 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015434 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15435 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015436
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015437ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15438 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15439 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15440 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015442ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15443 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15444 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15445 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15446 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015447
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015448ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15449 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15450 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15451 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15452 BoringSSL.
15453
15454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015455ssl_fc_sni : string
15456 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15457 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15458 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15459 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15460 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15461
15462 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15463 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15464 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015465 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015466 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015468 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015469 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15470 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015472ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15473 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15474 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015475
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015476
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154777.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015478------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015480Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15481sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15482only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15483For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15484be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15485can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15486sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15487for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15488content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015490payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015491 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015492 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15493 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015495payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15496 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015497 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015498 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015499
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015500req.hdrs : string
15501 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15502 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15503 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15504 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15505
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015506req.hdrs_bin : binary
15507 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15508 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15509 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15510 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15511 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15512 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15513
15514 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15515
15516 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15517 str: <int:length><bytes>
15518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015519req.len : integer
15520req_len : integer (deprecated)
15521 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15522 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15523 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15524 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15525 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15526 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15527 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15528 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015530req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15531 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015532 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15533 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15534 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15535 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015537 ACL alternatives :
15538 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015540req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15541 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15542 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15543 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15544 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015546 ACL alternatives :
15547 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015549 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015551req.proto_http : boolean
15552req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15553 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15554 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15555 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15556 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15557 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15558 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15559 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015561 Example:
15562 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15563 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15564 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015565 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015567req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15568rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15569 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15570 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15571 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15572 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15573 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15574 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15575 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015577 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15578 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15579 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15580 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15581 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15582 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015584 ACL derivatives :
15585 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015587 Example :
15588 listen tse-farm
15589 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15590 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15591 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15592 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15593 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15594 persist rdp-cookie
15595 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15596 # This is only useful makes sense if
15597 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15598 stick-table type string size 204800
15599 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15600 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15601 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015603 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15604 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015606req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15607rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15608 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15609 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15610 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15611 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015613 ACL derivatives :
15614 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015615
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015616req.ssl_alpn : string
15617 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15618 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15619 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15620 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15621 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15622 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015623 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015624
15625 Examples :
15626 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15627 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15628 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015629 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015630 default_backend bk_default
15631
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015632req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15633 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15634 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015635 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15636 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15637 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15638 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15639 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015641req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15642req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15643 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15644 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15645 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15646 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15647 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15648 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15649 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015651req.ssl_sni : string
15652req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15653 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15654 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15655 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15656 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15657 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15658 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15659 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15660 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15661 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15662 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15663 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15664 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015666 ACL derivatives :
15667 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015669 Examples :
15670 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15671 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15672 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15673 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15674 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015675
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015676req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15677 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15678 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15679 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15680 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15681 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15682 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15683 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15684 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15685 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687req.ssl_ver : integer
15688req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15689 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15690 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15691 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15692 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15693 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15694 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15695 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015696 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015697 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699 ACL derivatives :
15700 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015701
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015702res.len : integer
15703 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15704 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15705 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15706 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15707 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15708 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15709 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15710 content inspection.
15711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015712res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15713 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015714 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15715 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15716 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15717 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015719res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15720 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15721 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15722 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15723 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015725 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015726
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015727res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15728rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15729 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15730 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15731 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15732 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15733 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15734 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15735 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015737wait_end : boolean
15738 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15739 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015740 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15742 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015743 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015744 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15745 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747 Examples :
15748 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15749 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15750 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015752 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15753 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15754 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15755 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15756 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15757 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15758 tcp-request content reject
15759
15760
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157617.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762--------------------------------------
15763
15764It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15765This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15766data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15767its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15768HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15769content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15770to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15771more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15772response are indexed.
15773
15774base : string
15775 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15776 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15777 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15778 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15779 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15780 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15781 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15782 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15783
15784 ACL derivatives :
15785 base : exact string match
15786 base_beg : prefix match
15787 base_dir : subdir match
15788 base_dom : domain match
15789 base_end : suffix match
15790 base_len : length match
15791 base_reg : regex match
15792 base_sub : substring match
15793
15794base32 : integer
15795 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15796 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15797 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015798 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15799 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15800 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015801
15802base32+src : binary
15803 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15804 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15805 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15806 per-URL counters.
15807
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015808capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15809 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15810 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15811 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15812
15813capture.req.method : string
15814 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15815 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15816 because it's allocated.
15817
15818capture.req.uri : string
15819 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15820 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15821 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15822 allocated.
15823
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015824capture.req.ver : string
15825 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15826 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15827 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15828
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015829capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15830 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15831 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15832 The first entry is an index of 0.
15833 See also: "capture response header"
15834
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015835capture.res.ver : string
15836 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15837 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15838 persistent flag.
15839
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015840req.body : binary
15841 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15842 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15843 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15844 the first chunk is analyzed.
15845
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015846req.body_param([<name>) : string
15847 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15848 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15849 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15850 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15851 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15852 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15853 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15854 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15855 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15856 given.
15857
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015858req.body_len : integer
15859 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15860 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15861 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15862 "option http-buffer-request".
15863
15864req.body_size : integer
15865 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15866 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15867 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15868 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15869 "option http-buffer-request".
15870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871req.cook([<name>]) : string
15872cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15873 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15874 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15875 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15876 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15877 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15878 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15879 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15880 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15881
15882 ACL derivatives :
15883 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15884 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15885 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15886 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15887 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15888 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15889 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15890 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015892req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15893cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15894 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15895 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015897req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15898cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15899 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15900 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15901 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15902 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015904cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15905 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15906 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15907 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15908 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015909 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015910 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15911 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15912 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15913 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015915hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15916 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15917 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15918 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15919 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015920 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015922req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15923 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15924 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15925 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15926 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15927 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15928 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15929 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15930 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015932req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15933 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15934 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15935 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15936 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15939 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15940 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15941 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15942 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15943 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15944 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15945 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15946 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015947 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015948 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015949 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015951 ACL derivatives :
15952 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15953 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15954 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15955 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15956 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15957 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15958 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15959 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15960
15961req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15962hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15963 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15964 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15965 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15966 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15967 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15968 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15969 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15970 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15971 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15972
15973req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15974hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15975 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15976 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15977 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15978 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15979 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015980 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015981 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15982 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15983
15984req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15985hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15986 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15987 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15988 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15989 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15990 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15991 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15992 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15993
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010015994
15995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015996http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15997 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15998 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15999 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16000 basic auth is supported.
16001
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016002http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16003 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16004 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16005 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16006 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16008 basic auth is supported.
16009
16010 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016011 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16012 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16013 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16014 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016015
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016016http_auth_pass : string
16017 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16018 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16019 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16020
16021http_auth_type : string
16022 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16023 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16024 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16025
16026http_auth_user : string
16027 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16028 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16029 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016031http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016032 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16033 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016034 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16035 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016037method : integer + string
16038 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16039 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16040 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16041 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16042 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16043 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16044 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016046 ACL derivatives :
16047 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016049 Example :
16050 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16051 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16052 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016054path : string
16055 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16056 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16057 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16058 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16059 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016060 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016061 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016063 ACL derivatives :
16064 path : exact string match
16065 path_beg : prefix match
16066 path_dir : subdir match
16067 path_dom : domain match
16068 path_end : suffix match
16069 path_len : length match
16070 path_reg : regex match
16071 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016072
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016073query : string
16074 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16075 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16076 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16077 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016078 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016079 which stops before the question mark.
16080
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016081req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16082 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16083 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16084 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16085 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016087req.ver : string
16088req_ver : string (deprecated)
16089 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16090 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16091 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016093 ACL derivatives :
16094 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016096res.comp : boolean
16097 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16098 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16099 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016101res.comp_algo : string
16102 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16103 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16104 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016106res.cook([<name>]) : string
16107scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16108 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16109 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16110 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016112 ACL derivatives :
16113 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016115res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16116scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16117 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16118 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16119 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016121res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16122scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16123 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16124 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16125 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016127res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16128 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16129 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16130 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16131 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16132 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16133 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16134 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16135 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16136 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016138res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16139 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16140 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16141 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16142 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16143 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016145res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16146shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16147 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16148 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16149 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16150 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16151 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16152 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16153 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16154 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016156 ACL derivatives :
16157 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16158 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16159 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16160 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16161 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16162 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16163 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16164 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16165
16166res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16167shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16168 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16169 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16170 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16171 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16172 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016174res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16175shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16176 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16177 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16178 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16179 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16180 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16181 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016182
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016183res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16184 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16185 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16186 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16187 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016189res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16190shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16191 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16192 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16193 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16194 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16195 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16196 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016198res.ver : string
16199resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16200 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16201 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016203 ACL derivatives :
16204 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016206set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16207 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16208 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016209 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016210 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016212 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16213 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016215status : integer
16216 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16217 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16218 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016219
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016220unique-id : string
16221 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16222 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16223 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16224 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16225 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16226 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016228url : string
16229 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16230 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16231 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16232 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16233 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16234 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16235 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016237 ACL derivatives :
16238 url : exact string match
16239 url_beg : prefix match
16240 url_dir : subdir match
16241 url_dom : domain match
16242 url_end : suffix match
16243 url_len : length match
16244 url_reg : regex match
16245 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016247url_ip : ip
16248 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16249 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16250 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16251 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16252 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16253 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16254 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016256url_port : integer
16257 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16258 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16259 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16260 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016261
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016262urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16263url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016264 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16265 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016266 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16267 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16268 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16269 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016270 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16271 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016272 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16273 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016275 ACL derivatives :
16276 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16277 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16278 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16279 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16280 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16281 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16282 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16283 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016284
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016286 Example :
16287 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16288 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16289 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16290 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016291
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016292urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016293 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16294 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16295 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016296
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016297url32 : integer
16298 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16299 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16300 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16301 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16302 is an unsigned integer.
16303
16304url32+src : binary
16305 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16306 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16307 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16308
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200163107.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016311---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016313Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16314every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016315order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016317ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16318---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016319FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016320HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016321HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16322HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016323HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16324HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16325HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16326HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16327LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016328METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016329METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016330METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16331METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16332METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16333METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016334METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016335METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016336RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016337REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016338TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016339WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16340---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016341
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163438. Logging
16344----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016345
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016346One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16347provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16348very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16349provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16350state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016351to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016352headers.
16353
16354In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16355about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16356send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16357
16358 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16359 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16360 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16361 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16362 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016363 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016364 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016365
16366The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16367allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16368as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16369while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16370real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16371delay.
16372
16373
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163748.1. Log levels
16375---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016376
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016377TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016378source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016379HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16380in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16381track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16382syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16383about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016384
16385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163868.2. Log formats
16387----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016388
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016389HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016390and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16391slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16392options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016393
16394 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16395 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16396 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16397 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16398 extents.
16399
16400 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16401 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16402 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16403 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16404 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16405
16406 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16407 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16408 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16409 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16410 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16411
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016412 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16413 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16414 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16415 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16416
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016417 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16418
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016419Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16420specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16421field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16422servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16423always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16424identifier.
16425
16426Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16427 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16428 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16429 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16430 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16431
16432
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164338.2.1. Default log format
16434-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016435
16436This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16437as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16438format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16439
16440 Example :
16441 listen www
16442 mode http
16443 log global
16444 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16445
16446 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16447 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16448 (www/HTTP)
16449
16450 Field Format Extract from the example above
16451 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16452 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16453 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16454 4 'to' to
16455 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16456 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16457
16458Detailed fields description :
16459 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16460 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16461 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16462 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16463 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16464 and processed the connection.
16465 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16466
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016467In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16468"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16469connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16470
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016471It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16472will eventually disappear.
16473
16474
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164758.2.2. TCP log format
16476---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016477
16478The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16479is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16480information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16481counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16482emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16483environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16484the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16485sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016486specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16487not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16488fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16489marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016490
16491 Example :
16492 frontend fnt
16493 mode tcp
16494 option tcplog
16495 log global
16496 default_backend bck
16497
16498 backend bck
16499 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16500
16501 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16502 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16503 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16504
16505 Field Format Extract from the example above
16506 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16507 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16508 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16509 4 frontend_name fnt
16510 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16511 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16512 7 bytes_read* 212
16513 8 termination_state --
16514 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16515 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16516
16517Detailed fields description :
16518 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016519 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16520 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16521 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016522 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016523 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016524 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016525
16526 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016527 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16528 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16529 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016530
16531 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16532 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16533 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016534 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16535 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16536 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16537 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016538
16539 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16540 and processed the connection.
16541
16542 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16543 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16544 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16545 applications.
16546
16547 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16548 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16549 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16550 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16551 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16552
16553 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16554 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16555 See "Timers" below for more details.
16556
16557 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16558 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16559 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16560 "Timers" below for more details.
16561
16562 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016563 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016564 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16565 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16566 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16567 details.
16568
16569 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16570 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16571 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16572 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16573 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16574
16575 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16576 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16577 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16578 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16579 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16580 for more details.
16581
16582 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016583 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016584 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16585 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16586 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016587 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016588
16589 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16590 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16591 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16592 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16593 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16594 caused by a denial of service attack.
16595
16596 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16597 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16598 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16599 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16600 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16601 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16602 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16603 denial of service attack.
16604
16605 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16606 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16607 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16608 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16609 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16610 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16611 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16612 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16613 be processed than on other servers.
16614
16615 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16616 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16617 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16618 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16619 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16620 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16621 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16622 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16623 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16624 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16625 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16626 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16627 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16628
16629 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16630 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16631 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16632 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16633 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16634 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016635 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016636 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16637
16638 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16639 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16640 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16641 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16642 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16643 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016644 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016645 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16646 occurs.
16647
16648
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166498.2.3. HTTP log format
16650----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016651
16652The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16653is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16654the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16655are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16656emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16657generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16658"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16659which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016660frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16661is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016662
16663Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16664slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16665with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16666
16667 Example :
16668 frontend http-in
16669 mode http
16670 option httplog
16671 log global
16672 default_backend bck
16673
16674 backend static
16675 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16676
16677 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16678 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16679 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016680 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016681
16682 Field Format Extract from the example above
16683 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16684 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016685 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016686 4 frontend_name http-in
16687 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016688 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016689 7 status_code 200
16690 8 bytes_read* 2750
16691 9 captured_request_cookie -
16692 10 captured_response_cookie -
16693 11 termination_state ----
16694 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16695 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16696 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16697 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16698 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016699
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016700Detailed fields description :
16701 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016702 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16703 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16704 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016705 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016706 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016707 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016708
16709 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016710 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16711 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16712 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016713
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016714 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16715 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016716
16717 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16718 and processed the connection.
16719
16720 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16721 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16722 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16723
16724 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16725 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16726 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16727 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16728 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16729 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16730
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016731 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16732 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16733 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016734 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016735 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16736 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016737 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16738 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016739
16740 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16741 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016742 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016743
16744 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16745 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016746 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16747 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016748
16749 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16750 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16751 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16752 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16753 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016754 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16755 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016756
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016757 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16758 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16759 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16760 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16761 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16762 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16763 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016764 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016765
16766 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16767 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16768 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16769
16770 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16771 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016772 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016773 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16774 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16775 overflowing.
16776
16777 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16778 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16779 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16780 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16781 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16782 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16783 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16784 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16785
16786 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16787 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16788 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16789 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16790 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16791 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16792 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16793 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16794
16795 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16796 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16797 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16798 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16799 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16800 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16801 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16802
16803 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016804 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016805 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16806 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16807 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016808 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016809 system.
16810
16811 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16812 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16813 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16814 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16815 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16816 caused by a denial of service attack.
16817
16818 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16819 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16820 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16821 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16822 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16823 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16824 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16825 denial of service attack.
16826
16827 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16828 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16829 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16830 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16831 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16832 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16833 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16834 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16835 processed than on other servers.
16836
16837 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16838 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16839 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16840 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16841 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16842 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16843 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16844 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16845 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16846 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16847 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16848 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16849 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16850
16851 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16852 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16853 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16854 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16855 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16856 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016857 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016858 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16859
16860 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16861 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16862 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16863 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16864 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16865 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016866 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016867 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16868 occurs.
16869
16870 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16871 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16872 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16873 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16874 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16875 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16876 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16877 cookies" below for more details.
16878
16879 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16880 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16881 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16882 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16883 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16884 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16885 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16886 and cookies" below for more details.
16887
16888 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16889 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16890 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16891 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16892 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16893 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16894 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16895 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16896
16897
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200168988.2.4. Custom log format
16899------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016900
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016901The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016902mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016903
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016904HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016905Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16906separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16907prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16908
16909Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16910variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016911("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016912
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016913If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016914as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016915less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16916the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16917
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016918Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016919In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016920in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016921
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016922Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16923'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16924https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16925such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16926
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016927Flags are :
16928 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016929 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016930 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16931 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016932
16933 Example:
16934
16935 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16936 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16937
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016938 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16939
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016940At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16941
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016942 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16943 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016944
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016945the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016946
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016947 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16948 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16949 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016950
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016951and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16952
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016953 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16954 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016955
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016956Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16957
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016958 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016959 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016960 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16961 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16962 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016963 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16964 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16965 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016966 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016967 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16968 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016969 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016970 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16971 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016972 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016973 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016974 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016975 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016976 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016977 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016978 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016979 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16980 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16981 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16982 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16983 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016984 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016985 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16986 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016987 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016988 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16989 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016990 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16991 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16992 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016993 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016994 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16995 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016996 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016997 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16998 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16999 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017000 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017001 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017002 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17003 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17004 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17005 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017006 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017007 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017008 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017009 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017010 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017011 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017012 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17013 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17014 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017015 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017016 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17017 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017018 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017019 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17020 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017021 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017022 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017023 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017024 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017025
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017026 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017027
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017028
170298.2.5. Error log format
17030-----------------------
17031
17032When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17033protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17034By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17035"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017036will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017037logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17038
17039The format looks like this :
17040
17041 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17042 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17043 Connection error during SSL handshake
17044
17045 Field Format Extract from the example above
17046 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17047 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17048 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17049 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17050 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17051
17052These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17053failures.
17054
17055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170568.3. Advanced logging options
17057-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017058
17059Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17060just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17061options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17062for more information about their usage.
17063
17064
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170658.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17066------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017067
17068It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17069haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17070commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17071monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17072ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17073
17074 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17075 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17076 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17077 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17078
17079 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17080 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17081 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017082 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017083 such as other load-balancers.
17084
17085 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17086 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17087 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17088
17089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17091----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017092
17093The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17094what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17095or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017096"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017097just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17098log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17099after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17100is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17101with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17102with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17103
17104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17106------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017107
17108Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17109for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17110"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17111retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17112raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17113a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17114file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17115you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17116"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17117
17118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171198.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17120--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017121
17122Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17123multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17124them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17125"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17126logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17127error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17128and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17129too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17130useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17131alternative.
17132
17133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171348.4. Timing events
17135------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017136
17137Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17138reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17139the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17140frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017141mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17142addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17143
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017144Timings events in HTTP mode:
17145
17146 first request 2nd request
17147 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17148 t tr t tr ...
17149 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17150 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17151 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17152 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17153 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17154
17155Timings events in TCP mode:
17156
17157 TCP session
17158 |<----------------->|
17159 t t
17160 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17161 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17162 |<------ Tt ------->|
17163
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017164 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017165 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017166 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17167 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17168 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017169 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017170 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17171 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17172 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17173 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017174
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017175 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17176 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17177 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017178 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17179 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17180 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17181 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17182 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17183 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017184
17185 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17186 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17187 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17188 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17189 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17190 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17191 request typed by hand during a test.
17192
17193 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17194 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017195 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017196 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17197 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17198 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17199 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017200
17201 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17202 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17203 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17204 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17205 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17206
17207 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17208 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17209 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17210 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17211 connection never established.
17212
17213 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17214 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17215 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17216 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17217 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17218 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17219 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17220 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17221 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17222 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17223 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17224
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017225 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17226 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17227 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17228 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17229 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17230 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17231
17232 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17233
17234 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17235 "Ta" can never be negative.
17236
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017237 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17238 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017239 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17240 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017241 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017242
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017243 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017244
17245 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017246 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17247 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017248
17249These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17250protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17251that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017252due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17253"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17254that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017255
17256Most common cases :
17257
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017258 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17259 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17260 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17261 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17262 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17263 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17264 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17265 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17266 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17267 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17268 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017269 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017270
17271 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17272 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17273 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17274 of ms on remote networks.
17275
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017276 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17277 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17278 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017279
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017280 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17281 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17282 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17283 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17284 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17285 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17286 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17287 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17288 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017289
17290Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17291
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017292 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017293 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017294 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017295
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017296 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017297 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17298 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17299
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017300 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017301 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17302 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17303 flags.
17304
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017305 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17306 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017307 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17308 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17309 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17310 the client connection was maintained open.
17311
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017312 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017313 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017314 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017315 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17316
17317
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173188.5. Session state at disconnection
17319-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017320
17321TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17322"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
173232-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17324each of which has a special meaning :
17325
17326 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17327 session to terminate :
17328
17329 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17330
17331 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17332 server explicitly refused it.
17333
17334 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17335 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17336 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17337 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017338 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017339
17340 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17341 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017342
17343 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17344 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17345 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17346 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17347 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17348
17349 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17350 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17351 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17352 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17353 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17354
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017355 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17356 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17357
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017358 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17359 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17360 backup connections when going up.
17361
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017362 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17363
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017364 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17365 send or receive data.
17366
17367 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17368 send or receive data.
17369
17370 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17371 with nothing left in the buffers.
17372
17373 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17374
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017375 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017376 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17377
17378 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17379 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17380 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17381 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17382 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17383
17384 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17385 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17386
17387 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17388 server (HTTP only).
17389
17390 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17391
17392 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17393 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17394 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17395
17396 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17397 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17398 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17399
17400 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17401
17402 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17403 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17404
17405 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17406 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17407 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17408
17409 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17410 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017411 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17412 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017413
17414 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17415 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17416 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17417 another server.
17418
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017419 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017420 server.
17421
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017422 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17423 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17424 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17425 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17426
17427 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17428 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17429 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17430 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17431
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017432 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17433 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17434 "use-server" rule).
17435
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017436 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17437
17438 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17439 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17440
17441 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17442
17443 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17444 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17445 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17446
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017447 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17448 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017449 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017450 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17451 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17452
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017453 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17454
17455 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17456 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17457
17458 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17459
17460 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17461
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017462The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17463was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017464helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17465starvation, attacks, etc...
17466
17467The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17468alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17469easier finding and understanding.
17470
17471 Flags Reason
17472
17473 -- Normal termination.
17474
17475 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17476 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17477 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17478 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17479
17480 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17481 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17482 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17483 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17484 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17485 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017486
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017487 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17488 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017489 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017490
17491 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17492 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17493 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17494
17495 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17496 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17497 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17498 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17499 the server takes too long to respond.
17500
17501 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17502 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17503 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17504 long a time to respond.
17505
17506 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17507 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17508 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17509 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017510 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17511 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017512
17513 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17514 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17515 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17516 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17517 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017518 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017519 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17520 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17521 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17522 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17523 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17524 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17525 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17526 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017527 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017528 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17529 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17530 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017531
17532 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17533 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017534 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17535 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17536 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17537 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017538
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017539 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17540 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17541
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017542 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017543 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17544 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017545 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017546 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17547 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17548
17549 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17550 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17551 503 or 504 here.
17552
17553 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17554 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17555 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17556 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17557 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17558
17559 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17560 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017561 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017562 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17563 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17564
17565 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17566 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17567 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17568 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17569 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17570 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17571 between haproxy and the server.
17572
17573 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17574 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17575 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17576 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17577 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17578 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17579 solution is to fix the application.
17580
17581 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17582 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17583 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17584 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17585 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17586 external attacks.
17587
17588 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17589 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017590 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017591 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17592 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17593
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017594 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17595 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17596 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017597 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017598 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017599
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017600 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17601 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17602 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17603 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017604 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17605 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17606 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17607 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17608 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017609
17610 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17611 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17612 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17613 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17614
17615 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17616 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17617 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17618 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17619
17620 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17621 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17622 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17623 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17624
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017625The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17626persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17627important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17628re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17629
17630 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17631
17632 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17633 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17634 set on a GET request.
17635
17636 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17637 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017638 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017639 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17640
17641 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17642 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17643 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17644
17645 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17646 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17647 already got a cookie.
17648
17649 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17650 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17651 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17652 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17653 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17654
17655 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17656 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17657 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17658
17659 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17660 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17661 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17662
17663 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17664 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17665
17666 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17667 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17668 then advertised in the response.
17669
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176718.6. Non-printable characters
17672-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017673
17674In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17675consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17676converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17677prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17678being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17679escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17680is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17681'}' when logging headers.
17682
17683Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17684issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17685containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17686
17687Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17688the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17689performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17690
17691
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176928.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17693---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017694
17695Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17696achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017697section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017698cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17699the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17700the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017701locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017702not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17703user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17704a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17705wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17706
17707 Examples :
17708 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17709 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17710
17711 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17712 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17713
17714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177158.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17716---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017717
17718Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17719proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17720the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17721server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17722
17723Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17724response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017725section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017726
17727It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017728time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17729appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017730are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17731and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17732follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17733request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17734in the logs.
17735
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017736As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17737frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17738an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17739
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017740 Example :
17741 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17742 listen proxy-out
17743 mode http
17744 option httplog
17745 option logasap
17746 log global
17747 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17748
17749 # log the name of the virtual server
17750 capture request header Host len 20
17751
17752 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17753 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17754
17755 # log the beginning of the referrer
17756 capture request header Referer len 20
17757
17758 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17759 capture response header Server len 20
17760
17761 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17762 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17763
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017764 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017765 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17766
17767 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17768 capture response header Via len 20
17769
17770 # log the URL location during a redirection
17771 capture response header Location len 20
17772
17773 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17774 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17775 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17776 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17777 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17778
17779 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17780 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17781 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17782 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017783 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017784
17785 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17786 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17787 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17788 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17789 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017790 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017791
17792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177938.9. Examples of logs
17794---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017795
17796These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17797them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17798reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17799
17800 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17801 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17802 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17803
17804 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17805 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17806
17807 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17808 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17809 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17810
17811 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17812 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17813
17814 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17815 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17816 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17817
17818 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017819 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017820 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17821 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17822
17823 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17824 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17825 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17826
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017827 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
17828 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
17829 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
17830 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
17831 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
17832 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017833
17834 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017835 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017836
17837 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17838 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17839 Nothing was sent to any server.
17840
17841 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17842 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17843
17844 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17845 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017846 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017847 send a 408 return code to the client.
17848
17849 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17850 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17851
17852 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17853 5 seconds ("c----").
17854
17855 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17856 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017857 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017858
17859 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017860 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017861 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17862 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17863 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17864 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17865 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017866
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017867
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200178689. Supported filters
17869--------------------
17870
17871Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17872accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17873unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17874
17875See also : "filter"
17876
178779.1. Trace
17878----------
17879
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017880filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017881
17882 Arguments:
17883 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17884 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17885
17886 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17887 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17888 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17889 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17890
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017891 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017892 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17893 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17894 amount of the parsed data.
17895
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017896 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017897
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017898This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17899callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17900information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17901filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17902
17903Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17904tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17905a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17906
17907
179089.2. HTTP compression
17909---------------------
17910
17911filter compression
17912
17913The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17914keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017915when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
17916fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
17917done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
17918explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
17919filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
17920listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17921order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017922
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017923See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
17924 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017925
17926
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200179279.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17928--------------------------------------------
17929
17930filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17931
17932 Arguments :
17933
17934 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17935 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17936 parsed.
17937
17938 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17939 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17940 part must be placed in its own scope.
17941
17942The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17943external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017944streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017945exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17946also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17947
17948SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17949the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17950
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017951For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017952"doc/SPOE.txt".
17953
17954Important note:
17955 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17956 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17957
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100179589.4. Cache
17959----------
17960
17961filter cache <name>
17962
17963 Arguments :
17964
17965 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17966
17967The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17968"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017969cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017970other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
17971case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
17972is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17973filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017974listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17975order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017976
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017977See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
17978 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
17979
17980
179819.5. Fcgi-app
17982-------------
17983
17984filter fcg-app <name>
17985
17986 Arguments :
17987
17988 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
17989
17990The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
17991request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
17992reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
17993used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
17994implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
17995used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
17996fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
17997used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17998order.
17999
18000See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18001 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18002
18003
1800410. FastCGI applications
18005-------------------------
18006
18007HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18008feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18009the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18010FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18011servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18012FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18013backend.
18014
18015HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18016application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18017connection.
18018
1801910.1. Setup
18020-----------
18021
1802210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18023--------------------------
18024
18025fcgi-app <name>
18026 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18027 document root must be defined.
18028
18029acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18030 Declare or complete an access list.
18031
18032 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18033 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18034 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18035 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18036 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18037
18038docroot <path>
18039 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18040 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18041 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18042
18043index <script-name>
18044 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18045 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18046 is an optional setting.
18047
18048 Example :
18049 index index.php
18050
18051log-stderr global
18052log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18053 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18054 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18055
18056 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18057 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18058
18059pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18060 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18061 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18062 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18063
18064 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18065 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18066 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18067 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18068
18069 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18070 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18071
18072path-info <regex>
18073 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
18074 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
18075 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
18076 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18077 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
18078
18079 Example :
18080 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18081
18082option get-values
18083no option get-values
18084 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18085
18086 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18087 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18088
18089 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18090 application will accept.
18091
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018092 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18093 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018094
18095 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18096 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18097 option is disabled.
18098
18099 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18100 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18101 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18102 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18103 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18104 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18105
18106option keep-conn
18107no option keep-conn
18108 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18109 sending a response.
18110
18111 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18112 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18113
18114option max-reqs <reqs>
18115 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18116 accept.
18117
18118 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18119 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18120 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18121 to 1.
18122
18123option mpxs-conns
18124no option mpxs-conns
18125 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18126
18127 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18128 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18129
18130set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18131 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18132 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18133 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18134 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18135
18136 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18137 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18138 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18139
18140 Example :
18141 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18142 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18143
18144 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18145
18146
1814710.1.2. Proxy section
18148---------------------
18149
18150use-fcgi-app <name>
18151 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18152
18153 Arguments :
18154 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18155
18156 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18157 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18158 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18159 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18160 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18161
18162 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18163 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18164 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18165 application are evaluated.
18166
18167
1816810.1.3. Example
18169---------------
18170
18171 frontend front-http
18172 mode http
18173 bind *:80
18174 bind *:
18175
18176 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18177 default_backend back-static
18178
18179 backend back-static
18180 mode http
18181 server www A.B.C.D:80
18182
18183 backend back-dynamic
18184 mode http
18185 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18186 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18187
18188 fcgi-app php-fpm
18189 log-stderr global
18190 option keep-conn
18191
18192 docroot /var/www/my-app
18193 index index.php
18194 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18195
18196
1819710.2. Default parameters
18198------------------------
18199
18200A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18201the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18202scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18203applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18204
18205 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18206 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18207 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18208 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18209 | | |
18210 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18211 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18212 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18213 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18214 | | application. |
18215 | | |
18216 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18217 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18218 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18219 | | |
18220 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18221 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18222 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18223 | | the application's configuration. |
18224 | | |
18225 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18226 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18227 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18228 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18229 | | |
18230 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18231 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18232 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18233 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18234 | | be defined. |
18235 | | |
18236 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18237 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18238 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18239 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18240 | | is not set too. |
18241 | | |
18242 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18243 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18244 | | set. |
18245 | | |
18246 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18247 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18248 | | the request. |
18249 | | |
18250 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18251 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18252 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18253 | | |
18254 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18255 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18256 | | script to process the request. |
18257 | | |
18258 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18259 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18260 | | |
18261 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18262 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18263 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18264 | | |
18265 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18266 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18267 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18268 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18269 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18270 | | |
18271 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18272 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18273 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18274 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18275 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18276 | | side. |
18277 | | |
18278 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18279 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18280 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18281 | | connected to. |
18282 | | |
18283 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18284 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18285 | | |
18286 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18287 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18288 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18289 | | |
18290 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18291
18292
1829310.3. Limitations
18294------------------
18295
18296The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18297way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18298during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18299establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18300application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18301or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18302message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18303these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18304and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18305
18306Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18307request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18308requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18309
18310About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18311into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18312fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18313"http-request" ones.
18314
18315Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18316FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18317processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18318must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18319here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018320
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018321/*
18322 * Local variables:
18323 * fill-column: 79
18324 * End:
18325 */